2002 TL Online Reference Owner's...

339
2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout this manual) to navigate through this reference. For a printed owner's manual, click on authorized manuals or go to www.helminc.com. Contents Owner's Identification Form Introduction ......................................................................................................................................... i A Few Words About Safety ................................................................................................................. ii Your Car at a Glance ........................................................................................................................... 2 Driver and Passenger Safety .............................................................................................................. 5 Proper use and care of your car's seat belts, and Supplemental Restraint System. Instruments and Controls ................................................................................................................. 55 Instrument panel indicator and gauge, and how to use dashboard and steering column controls. Comfort and Convenience Features .............................................................................................. 115 How to operate the climate control system, the audio system, and other convenience features. Before Driving.................................................................................................................................. 163 What gasoline to use, how to break-in your new car, and how to load luggage and other cargo. Driving .............................................................................................................................................. 177 The proper way to start the engine, shift the transmission, and park, plus towing a trailer. Maintenance ..................................................................................................................................... 209 The Maintenance Schedule shows you when you need to take your car to the dealer. Appearance Care.............................................................................................................................. 269 Tips on cleaning and protecting your car. Things to look for if your car ever needs body repairs. Taking Care of the Unexpected ...................................................................................................... 277 This section covers several problems motorists sometimes experience, and how to handle them. Technical Information..................................................................................................................... 305 ID numbers, dimensions, capacities, and technical information. Warranty and Customer Relations (U.S. and Canada) ................................................................ 319 A summary of the warranties covering your new Acura, and how to contact us. Authorized Manuals (U.S. only)...................................................................................................... 325 How to order manuals and other technical literature. Index...................................................................................................................................................... I Service Information Summary A summary of information you need when you pull up to the fuel pump.

Transcript of 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's...

Page 1: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout this manual) to navigate through this reference. For a printed owner's manual, click on authorized manuals or go to www.helminc.com. Contents

Owner's Identification Form Introduction ......................................................................................................................................... i A Few Words About Safety ................................................................................................................. ii

Your Car at a Glance ...........................................................................................................................2

Driver and Passenger Safety ..............................................................................................................5 Proper use and care of your car's seat belts, and Supplemental Restraint System. Instruments and Controls ................................................................................................................. 55 Instrument panel indicator and gauge, and how to use dashboard and steering column controls. Comfort and Convenience Features .............................................................................................. 115 How to operate the climate control system, the audio system, and other convenience features. Before Driving.................................................................................................................................. 163 What gasoline to use, how to break-in your new car, and how to load luggage and other cargo. Driving .............................................................................................................................................. 177 The proper way to start the engine, shift the transmission, and park, plus towing a trailer. Maintenance ..................................................................................................................................... 209 The Maintenance Schedule shows you when you need to take your car to the dealer. Appearance Care.............................................................................................................................. 269 Tips on cleaning and protecting your car. Things to look for if your car ever needs body repairs. Taking Care of the Unexpected ...................................................................................................... 277 This section covers several problems motorists sometimes experience, and how to handle them. Technical Information..................................................................................................................... 305 ID numbers, dimensions, capacities, and technical information. Warranty and Customer Relations (U.S. and Canada) ................................................................ 319 A summary of the warranties covering your new Acura, and how to contact us. Authorized Manuals (U.S. only)...................................................................................................... 325 How to order manuals and other technical literature. Index...................................................................................................................................................... I Service Information Summary A summary of information you need when you pull up to the fuel pump.

Page 2: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The information and specificationsincluded in this publication were ineffect at the time of approval forprinting. Honda Motor Co., Ltd.reserves the right, however, todiscontinue or change specificationsor design at any time without noticeand without incurring any obligationwhatsoever.

This Owner’s Manual covers allmodels of the Acura 3.2 TL. You mayfind descriptions of equipment andfeatures that are not on yourparticular model.

This Owner’s Manual should beconsidered a permanent part of thecar, and should remain with the carwhen it is sold.

Owner’s Identif ication

OWNER

ADDRESS

V. I. N.

DELIVERY DATE

DEALER NAME DEALER NO.

ADDRESS

OWNER’S SIGNATURE

DEALER’S SIGNATURE

STREET

CITY STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/POSTAL CODE

(Date sold to original retail purchaser)

STREET

CITY STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/POSTAL CODE

00/12/25 13:52:28 31S0K630_001

Page 3: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

One of the best ways to enhance the enjoyment of your new Acura is to readthis manual. In it, you will learn how to operate its driving controls andconvenience items. Afterwards, keep this owner’s manual in your car so youcan refer to it at any time.

Several warranties protect your new Acura. Read the warranty bookletthoroughly so you understand the coverages and are aware of your rightsand responsibilities.

Maintaining your car according to the schedules given in this manual helpsto keep your driving trouble-free while it preserves your investment. Whenyour car needs maintenance, keep in mind that your Acura dealer’s staff isspecially trained in servicing the many systems unique to your Acura. YourAcura dealer is dedicated to your satisfaction and will be pleased to answerany questions and concerns.

As you read this manual, you willfind information that is preceded bya symbol. Thisinformation is intended to help youavoid damage to your Acura, otherproperty, or the environment.

California Proposition 65 Warning

This product contains or emits chemicals known to the State ofCalifornia to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm.

Congratulations! Your selection of a 2002 Acura 3.2 TL was a wiseinvestment. It will give you years of driving pleasure.

Introduction

WARNING:

i

00/12/25 13:52:36 31S0K630_002

Page 4: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To help you make informeddecisions about safety, we haveprovided operating procedures andother information on labels and inthis manual. This information alertsyou to potential hazards that couldhurt you or others.

You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms,including:

preceded by a safety alert symbol and one ofthree signal words: , , or .These signal words mean:

such as Driver and Passenger Safety.

This entire book is filled with important safety information please read itcarefully.

such as Important Safety Reminders or ImportantSafety Precautions.

Of course, it is not practical orpossible to warn you about all thehazards associated with operating ormaintaining your car. You must useyour own good judgement.

on the car.

Your safety, and the safety of others,is very important. And operating thiscar safely is an importantresponsibility.

how to use this car correctly and safely.

A Few Words About Safety

Safety Messages

Safety Section

Safety Headings

Safety Labels

Instructions

DANGER WARNING CAUTION

ii

You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLYHURT if you don’t follow instructions.

You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLYHURT if you don’t follow instructions.

You CAN be HURT if you don’t followinstructions.

00/12/25 13:52:50 31S0K630_003

Page 5: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Your Car at a Glance

2

DDIIGGIITTAALL CCLLOOCCKK

PPOOWWEERR WWIINNDDOOWWSSWWIITTCCHHEESS

HHOOOODD RREELLEEAASSEEHHAANNDDLLEE

MMIIRRRROORRCCOONNTTRROOLLSS

AAUUDDIIOO SSYYSSTTEEMM

TTRRUUNNKK RREELLEEAASSEEBBUUTTTTOONN

AAIIRRBBAAGGSS

AAUUTTOOMMAATTIICCTTRRAANNSSMMIISSSSIIOONN

CCLLIIMMAATTEE CCOONNTTRROOLLSSYYSSTTEEMM

PPOOWWEERR DDOOOORRLLOOCCKKSS

FFUUEELL FFIILLLL DDOOOORRRREELLEEAASSEE HHAANNDDLLEE((PP..116655)) ((PP..116666)) ((PP..118800))

((PP..99,, 4477))DDRRIIVVIINNGG PPOOSSIITTIIOONNMMEEMMOORRYY((PP..9966))

((PP..7799))

((PP..110000))

((PP..9944))

((PP..8855))

((PP..112299))

((PP..111166,, 112233))

((PP..110055))

00/12/25 13:53:17 31S0K630_005

Page 6: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Your Car at a Glance

3

HHEEAADDLLIIGGHHTTSS//TTUURRNN SSIIGGNNAALLSS

HHAAZZAARRDD WWAARRNNIINNGGLLIIGGHHTTSS

WWIINNDDSSHHIIEELLDD WWIIPPEERRSS//WWAASSHHEERRSS

TTIILLTT AADDJJUUSSTTMMEENNTT RREEAARR WWIINNDDOOWW DDEEFFOOGGGGEERR

HHOORRNNCCRRUUIISSEE CCOONNTTRROOLL

IINNSSTTRRUUMMEENNTT PPAANNEELLBBRRIIGGHHTTNNEESSSS

MMOOOONNRROOOOFF SSWWIITTCCHH

FFOOGG LLIIGGHHTTSS

((PP..6699,, 7711))((PP..7722,, 7733))

((PP..7733))

((PP..7744))

((PP..6688))

((PP..7755))

((PP..110033))

((PP..7711))

((PP..115533))

TTRRAACCTTIIOONN CCOONNTTRROOLL//VVEEHHIICCLLEE SSTTAABBIILLIITTYY AASSSSIISSTTSSYYSSTTEEMM OONN//OOFFFF SSWWIITTCCHH((PP..119944,, 119977))

((PP..7700))

00/12/25 13:53:24 31S0K630_006

Page 7: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

4

Page 8: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

This section gives you importantinformation about how to protectyourself and your passengers. Itshows you how to use seat beltsproperly. It explains your Supple-mental Restraint System. And it tellsyou how to properly restrain infantsand children in your car.

.........Important Safety Precautions . 6.............Your Car’s Safety Features . 7

.......................................Seat Belts . 8...........................................Airbags . 9

.....................Seats & Seat-Backs . 10..........................Head Restraints . 10

..................................Door Locks . 10........Pre-Drive Safety Checklist . 11

............................Protecting Adults . 12.....1. Close and Lock the Doors . 12

...........2. Adjust the Front Seats . 13............3. Adjust the Seat-Backs . 14

...4. Adjust the Head Restraints . 155. Fasten and Position the Seat

.....................................Belts . 15....6. Adjust the Steering Wheel . 18

7. Maintain a Proper Sitting................................Position . 18

.....Advice for Pregnant Women . 19...Additional Safety Precautions . 20

........................Protecting Children . 21All Children Must Be

...............................Restrained . 21Children Should Sit in the Back

...........................................Seat . 22The Passenger’s Front Airbag

Poses Serious Risks...........................to Children . 22

If You Must Drive with Several...................................Children . 25

If a Child Requires Close..................................Attention . 25

...Additional Safety Precautions . 25General Guidelines for Using

...............................Child Seats . 26.......................Protecting Infants . 30

.........Protecting Small Children . 33.......Protecting Larger Children . 37

Using Child Seats with.....................................Tethers . 41

.............................Using LATCH . 42Additional Information About Your

.................................Seat Belts . 44..Seat Belt System Components . 44

......................Lap/Shoulder Belt . 44Automatic Seat Belt

...............................Tensioners . 45...............Seat Belt Maintenance . 46

Additional Information About Your.....................................Airbags . 47

........................SRS Components . 47How Your Front Airbags

.........................................Work . 47...How Your Side Airbags Work . 49

How the SRS Indicator Light.......................................Works . 50

How The Side Airbag Indicator............................Light Works . 51.............................Airbag Service . 52

...Additional Safety Precautions . 52.............Carbon Monoxide Hazard . 53

...................................Safety Labels . 54

Driver and Passenger Safety

Driver and Passenger Safety

5

00/12/25 13:53:32 31S0K630_008

Page 9: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

You’ll find many safetyrecommendations throughout thissection, and throughout this manual.The recommendations on this pageare the ones we consider to be themost important.

Excessive speed is a major factor incrash injuries and deaths. Generally,the higher the speed the greater therisk, but serious accidents can alsooccur at lower speeds. Never drivefaster than is safe for currentconditions, regardless of themaximum speed posted.A seat belt is your best protection in

all types of collisions. Airbagssupplement seat belts, but airbagsare designed to inflate only in amoderate to severe frontal collision.So even though your car is equippedwith airbags, make sure you andyour passengers always wear yourseat belts, and wear them properly.(See page .)

Children are safest when they areproperly restrained in the back seat,not the front seat. A child who is toosmall for a seat belt must be properlyrestrained in a child safety seat. (Seepage .)

Having a tire blowout or amechanical failure can be extremelyhazardous. To reduce the possibilityof such problems, check your tirepressures and condition frequently,and perform all regularly scheduledmaintenance. (See page .)

Alcohol and driving don’t mix. Evenone drink can reduce your ability torespond to changing conditions, andyour reaction time gets worse withevery additional drink. So don’t drinkand drive, and don’t let your friendsdrink and drive, either.

While airbags can save lives, theycan cause serious or fatal injuries tooccupants who sit too close to them,or are not properly restrained.Infants, young children, and shortadults are at the greatest risk. Besure to follow all instructions andwarnings in this manual. (See page

.)9

15

21

214

Driver and Passenger Safety

Important Safety Precautions

Always Wear Your Seat Belt

Be Aware of Airbag Hazards Control Your Speed

Keep Your Car in Safe Condition

Restrain All Children

Don’t Drink and Drive

6

00/12/25 13:53:46 31S0K630_009

Page 10: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Your car is equipped with manyfeatures that work together toprotect you and your passengersduring a crash.

Some safety features do not requireany action on your part. Theseinclude a strong steel frameworkthat forms a safety cage around thepassenger compartment; front andrear crush zones that are designed tocrumple and absorb energy during acrash; a collapsible steering column;and seat belt tensioners thatautomatically tighten the front seatbelts in the event of a crash.

CONTINUED

Driver and Passenger Safety

Your Car’s Safety Features

7

((55))((77))

((66))

((22))

((22))

((11))((33))((88))

((77))

((44))((99))

((1100))((99))

((11)) SSaaffeettyy CCaaggee

((22)) CCrruusshh ZZoonneess

((33)) SSeeaattss && SSeeaatt--BBaacckkss

((44)) HHeeaadd RReessttrraaiinnttss

((55)) CCoollllaappssiibbllee SStteeeerriinngg CCoolluummnn

((66)) SSeeaatt BBeellttss

((77)) FFrroonntt AAiirrbbaaggss

((88)) DDoooorr LLoocckkss

((99)) SSiiddee AAiirrbbaaggss

((1100)) SSeeaatt BBeelltt TTeennssiioonneerrss

00/12/25 13:53:55 31S0K630_010

Page 11: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

In addition, most states and allCanadian provinces require you towear seat belts.

When properly worn, seat belts:

Keep you connected to the vehicleso you can take advantage of thecar’s built-in safety features.

Help protect you in almost everytype of crash, including frontal,side, and rear impacts androllovers.

For your safety, and the safety ofyour passengers, your car isequipped with seat belts in all seatingpositions.

Your seat belt system alsoincludes a light on the

instrument panel to remind you andyour passengers to fasten your seatbelts.

Seat belts are the single mosteffective safety device for adults andlarger children. (Infants and smallerchildren must be properly restrainedin child seats.)

Not wearing a seat belt properlyincreases the chance of seriousinjury or death in a crash, eventhough your car has airbags.

These safety features are designedto reduce the severity of injuries in acrash. However, you and yourpassengers can’t take full advantageof these safety features unless youremain sitting in a proper positionand

In fact, some safetyfeatures can contribute to injuries ifthey are not used properly.

Driver and Passenger Safety

Your Car’s Safety Features

Seat Belts

Why Wear Seat Belts

always wear your seat beltsproperly.

8

Not wearing a seat belt properlyincreases the chance of seriousinjury or death in a crash, evenif you have airbags.

Be sure you and yourpassengers always wear seatbelts and wear them properly.

00/12/25 13:54:07 31S0K630_011

Page 12: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

Your car also has side airbags to helpprotect the upper torso of the driveror a front seat passenger during amoderate to severe side impact.

The most important things you needto know about your airbags are:

They are designed to supplementthe seat belts.

Your car has a SupplementalRestraint System (SRS) with frontairbags to help protect the heads andchests of the driver and a front seatpassenger during a moderate tosevere frontal collision.

Help keep you from being thrownagainst the inside of the vehicleand against other occupants.

Keep you from being thrown outof the vehicle.

Help keep you in a good positionshould the airbags ever deploy. Agood position reduces the risk ofinjury from an inflating airbag, andallows you to get the bestadvantage from the airbag.

Of course, seat belts cannotcompletely protect you in everycrash. But in most cases, seat beltscan reduce your risk of seriousinjury.

Always wearyour seat belt, and make sure youwear it properly.

Driver and Passenger Safety

Your Car’s Safety Features

Airbags do not replace seat belts.

What you should do:

Airbags

9

00/12/25 13:54:22 31S0K630_012

Page 13: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Keeping your doors locked reducesthe chance of being thrown out ofthe car during a crash. It also helpsprevent occupants from accidentallyopening a door and falling out, andoutsiders from unexpectedly openingyour doors.

Head restraints can help protect youfrom whiplash and other injuries. Formaximum protection, the back ofyour head should rest against thecenter of the head restraint.

Move the frontseats as far back as possible, andkeep adjustable seat-backs in anupright position whenever the car ismoving.

Your car’s seats are designed to keepyou in a comfortable, uprightposition so you can take fulladvantage of the protection offeredby seat belts and the energyabsorbing materials in the seats.

How you adjust your seats and seat-backs can also affect your safety. Forexample, sitting too close to thesteering wheel or dashboardincreases the risk of you or yourpassenger being injured by strikingthe inside of the car, or by aninflating airbag.

Reclining a seat-back too far reducesthe seat belt’s effectiveness andincreases the chance that the seat’soccupant will slide under the seatbelt in a crash and be seriouslyinjured.

To do their job, airbags mustinflate with tremendous force andspeed. So while airbags help savelives, they can cause minor injuries,or more serious or even fatalinjuries if occupants are notproperly restrained or sittingproperly.

Always wearyour seat belt properly, and situpright and as far back as possiblefrom the steering wheel ordashboard.

Driver and Passenger Safety

Your Car’s Safety Features

Door Locks

Head Restraints

Seats & Seat-Backs What you should do:Airbags offer no protection in rearimpacts, rollovers, or minorfrontal or side collisions.

Airbags can pose serious hazards.

What you should do:

10

00/12/25 13:54:34 31S0K630_013

Page 14: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

All adults, and children who haveoutgrown child safety seats, arewearing their seat belts andwearing them properly (see page

).

Any infant or small child isproperly restrained in a child seatin the back seat (see page ).

To make sure you and yourpassengers get the maximumprotection from your car’s safetyfeatures, check the following eachtime before you drive away:

The rest of this section gives moredetailed information about how youcan maximize your safety.

Remember, however, that no safetysystem can prevent all injuries ordeaths that can occur in severecrashes, even when seat belts areproperly worn and the airbags deploy.Head restraints are properly

adjusted (see page ).

All doors are closed and locked(see page ).

Front seat occupants are sittingupright and as far back as possiblefrom the steering wheel anddashboard (see page ).

All cargo is properly stored orsecured (see page ).

Seat-backs are upright (see page).

1215

21

13

14

15

173

Driver and Passenger Safety

Pre-Drive Safety Checklist

Your Car’s Safety Features

11

00/12/25 13:54:46 31S0K630_014

Page 15: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The following pages provideinstructions on how to properlyprotect the driver and other adultoccupants.

These instructions also apply tochildren who have outgrown childseats and are large enough to wearlap/shoulder belts. (See page forimportant additional guidelines onhow to properly protect largerchildren.)

For security, locked doors canprevent an outsider fromunexpectedly opening a door whenyou come to a stop.

See page for how to lock thedoors.

For safety, locking the doors reducesthe chance that a passenger,especially a child, will open a doorwhile the car is moving andaccidentally fall out. It also reducesthe chance of someone being thrownout of the car during a crash.

Your car has a door monitor light onthe instrument panel to indicatewhen a specific door is not tightlyclosed.

After everyone has entered the car,be sure the doors are closed andlocked.

37

79

Driver and Passenger Safety

Protecting Adults

Introduction Close and Lock the Doors1.

12

00/12/25 13:54:58 31S0K630_015

Page 16: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Any driver who sits too close to thesteering wheel is at risk of beingseriously injured or killed by strikingthe steering wheel or from beingstruck by an inflating front airbagduring a crash.

To reduce the chance of injury, wearyour seat belt properly, sit uprightwith your back against the seat andmove the seat away from thesteering wheel to the farthestdistance that allows you maintain fullcontrol of the car.

See page for how to adjust thefront seats.

Once your seat is adjusted correctly,rock it back and forth to make surethe seat is locked in position.

Most shorter drivers can get farenough away from the steeringwheel and still reach the pedals.However, if you are concerned aboutsitting too close, we recommend thatyou investigate whether some typeof adaptive equipment may help.

The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that driversadjust the seat so the center of thechest is at least 10 inches away fromthe center of the steering wheel.Also make sure your front seatpassenger moves the seat as far tothe rear as possible.

88

Driver and Passenger Safety

Protecting Adults

Adjust the Front Seats2.

13

Sitting too close to a frontairbag can result in seriousinjury or death if the frontairbags inflate.

Always sit as far back from thefront airbags as possible.

00/12/25 13:55:08 31S0K630_016

Page 17: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

See page for how to adjust seat-backs.

A front passenger should also adjustthe seat-back to an upright position,but as far from the dashboard aspossible. A passenger who sits tooclose to the dashboard could beinjured if the front airbag inflates.

Reclining a seat-back so that theshoulder part of the belt no longerrests against the occupant’s chestreduces the protective capability ofthe belt. It also increases the chanceof sliding under the belt in a crashand being seriously injured. Thefarther a seat-back is reclined, thegreater the risk of injury.

Adjust the driver’s seat-back to acomfortable, upright position,leaving ample space between yourchest and the airbag cover in thecenter of the steering wheel. If yousit too close to the steering wheel,you could be injured if the frontairbag inflates.

89

Driver and Passenger Safety

Protecting Adults

Adjust the Seat-Backs3.

14

Reclining the seat-back too farcan result in serious injury ordeath in a crash.

Adjust the seat-back to anupright position and sit wellback in the seat.

00/12/25 13:55:17 31S0K630_017

Page 18: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Before driving, make sure everyonewith an adjustable head restraint hasproperly positioned the headrestraint. The restraint should bepositioned so the back of theoccupant’s head rests against thecenter of the restraint. A tallerperson should adjust the restraint ashigh as possible.

Properly adjusted head restraintswill help protect occupants fromwhiplash and other crash injuries.

See page for how to adjust thehead restraints.

Insert the latch plate into the buckle,then tug on the belt to make sure thebelt is securely latched. Also checkthat the belt is not twisted, because atwisted belt can cause seriousinjuries in a crash.

91

CONTINUED

Adjust the Head Restraints Fasten and Position the SeatBelts

4. 5.

Protecting Adults

Driver and Passenger Safety 15

Improperly positioning headrestraints reduces theireffectiveness and you can beseriously injured in a crash.

Make sure head restraints arein place and positioned properlybefore driving.

00/12/25 13:55:27 31S0K630_018

Page 19: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Position the lap part of the belt aslow as possible across your hips,then pull up on the shoulder part ofthe belt so the lap part fits snugly.This lets your strong pelvic bonestake the force of a crash and reducesthe chance of internal injuries.

If necessary, pull up on the belt againto remove any slack from theshoulder part, then check that thebelt rests across the center of yourchest and over your shoulder. Thisspreads the forces of a crash overthe strongest bones in your upperbody.

If the seat belt touches or crossesyour neck, or if it crosses your arminstead of your shoulder, you need toadjust the seat belt anchor height.

Protecting Adults

Driver and Passenger Safety16

Improperly positioning the seatbelts can cause serious injuryor death in a crash.

Make sure all seat belts areproperly positioned beforedriving.

00/12/25 13:55:34 31S0K630_019

Page 20: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To adjust the height of a front seatbelt anchor, press the release buttonand slide the anchor up or down asneeded (it has four positions).

This could causevery serious injuries in a crash.

If a seat belt does not seem to workas it should, it may not protect theoccupant in a crash.

Anyone using a seat belt that isnot working properly can beseriously injured or killed. Have yourAcura dealer check the belt as soonas possible.

See page for additionalinformation about your seat beltsystem and how to take care of yourbelts.

44

Protecting Adults

Driver and Passenger Safety

Never place the shoulder portion of alap/shoulder belt under your arm orbehind your back.

No one shouldsit in a seat with an inoperative seatbelt.

17

00/12/25 13:55:42 31S0K630_020

Page 21: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Adjust the steering wheel, if needed,so that the wheel points toward yourchest, not toward your face.

Pointing the steering wheel towardyour chest provides optimalprotection from the airbag.

See page for how to adjust thesteering wheel.

After all occupants have adjustedtheir seats and put on seat belts, it isvery important that they continue tosit upright, well back in their seats,with their feet on the floor, until thecar is parked and the engine is off.

Sitting improperly can increase thechance of injury during a crash. Forexample, if an occupant slouches,lies down, turns sideways, sitsforward, leans forward or sideways,or puts one or both feet up, thechance of injury during a crash isgreatly increased.

In addition, an occupant who is out ofposition in the front seat can beseriously or fatally injured bystriking interior parts of the car, orby being struck by an inflating frontairbag. Being struck by an inflatingside airbag can result in possiblyserious injuries.

75

Adjust the Steering Wheel Maintain a Proper SittingPosition

6. 7.

Protecting Adults

Driver and Passenger Safety18

Sitting improperly or out ofposition can result in seriousinjury or death in a crash.

Always sit upright, well back inthe seat, with your feet on thefloor.

00/12/25 13:55:53 31S0K630_021

Page 22: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Because protecting the mother is thebest way to protect her unborn child,a pregnant woman should alwayswear a seat belt whenever she drivesor rides in a car.

Pregnant women should also situpright and as far back as possiblefrom the steering wheel ordashboard. This will reduce the riskof injuries to both the mother andher unborn child that can be causedby a crash or an inflating airbag.

Each time you have a check-up, askyour doctor if it’s okay for you todrive.

Remember to keep the lap portion ofthe belt as low as possible acrossyour hips.

Remember, to get the bestprotection from your car’s airbagsand other safety features, you mustsit properly and wear your seat beltproperly.

Advice for Pregnant Women

Protecting Adults

Driver and Passenger Safety 19

00/12/25 13:56:03 31S0K630_022

Page 23: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in acrash.

Devices intended to improveoccupant comfort or reposition theshoulder part of a seat belt canseverely compromise theprotective capability of the seatbelt and increase the chance ofserious injury in a crash.

Carrying hard or sharpobjects on your lap, or driving witha pipe or other sharp object inyour mouth, can result in injuriesif your front airbag inflates.

If a side airbaginflates, a cup holder or other hardobject attached on or near thedoor could be propelled inside thecar and hurt someone.

If yourhands or arms are close to theairbag cover in the center of thesteering wheel or on top of thedashboard, they could be injured ifthe front airbags inflate.

Any objectattached to or placed on the coversmarked ‘‘SRS AIRBAG’’ in thecenter of the steering wheel andon top of the dashboard couldinterfere with the proper operationof the airbags. Or, if the airbagsinflate, the objects could bepropelled inside the car and hurtsomeone.

Additional Safety PrecautionsTwo people should never use thesame seat belt.

Do not put any accessories on seatbelts.

Do not place hard or sharp objectsbetween yourself and a frontairbag.

Do not attach hard objects on ornear a front door.

Keep your hands and arms awayfrom the airbag covers.Do not attach or place objects on

the front airbag covers.

Protecting Adults

Driver and Passenger Safety20

00/12/25 13:56:12 31S0K630_023

Page 24: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Children depend on adults to protectthem. However, despite their bestintentions, many parents and otheradults may not know how toprotect young passengers.

To reduce the number of childdeaths and injuries, every state andCanadian province requires thatinfants and children be restrainedwhenever they ride in a vehicle.

Each year, many children are injuredor killed in vehicle crashes becausethey are either unrestrained or notproperly restrained. In fact, vehicleaccidents are the number one causeof death of children ages 12 andunder.

So if you have children, or if you everneed to drive with a grandchild orother children in your car, be sure toread this section.

(See page.)

(See page.)

26

37

properly

All Children Must Be Restrained

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

Any child who is too small to wear aseat belt should be properlyrestrained in a child seat.

A larger child should always berestrained with a seat belt.

21

Children who are unrestrainedor improperly restrained can beseriously injured or killed in acrash.

Any child too small for a seatbelt should be properlyrestrained in a child seat. Alarger child should be properlyrestrained with a seat belt.

00/12/25 13:56:22 31S0K630_024

Page 25: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Front airbags have been designed tohelp protect adults in a moderate tosevere frontal collision. To do this,the passenger’s front airbag is quitelarge, and it inflates with tremendousspeed.

According to accident statistics,children of all ages and sizes aresafer when they are restrained in theback seat, not the front seat. TheNational Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that all childrenages 12 and under be properlyrestrained in the back seat.

In the back seat, children are lesslikely to be injured by striking hardinterior parts during a collision orhard braking. Also, children cannotbe injured by an inflating airbagwhen they ride in the back.

If you are not wearing aseat belt in a crush, you could bethrown forward into thedashboard and crush the child. Ifyou are wearing a seat belt, thechild can be torn from your armsduring a crush. For example, ifyour car crushes into a parkedvehicle at 30 mph (48 km/h), a20-lb (9 kg) infant will become a600-lb (275 kg) force, and you willnot be able to hold on.

During acrash, the belt could press deepinto the child and cause veryserious injuries.

The Passenger’s Front AirbagPoses Serious Risks to Children

Children Should Sit in the BackSeat

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

Additional Precautions to ParentsNever hold an infant or child onyour lap.

Never put a seat belt over yourselfand an infant or child.

22

00/12/25 13:56:32 31S0K630_025

Page 26: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

Ifthe airbag inflates, it can hit the backof the child seat with enough forceto kill or very seriously injure aninfant.

If the vehicle seat istoo far forward, or the child’s head isthrown forward during a collision, aninflating front airbag can strike thechild with enough force to kill orvery seriously injure a small child.

Whenever possible,larger children should sit in the backseat, properly restrained with a seatbelt. (See page for importantinformation about protecting largerchildren.)

37

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

InfantsNever put a rear-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag.

Small ChildrenPlacing a forward-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag canbe hazardous.

Larger ChildrenChildren who have outgrown childseats are also at risk of being injuredor killed by an inflating passenger’sfront airbag.

23

00/12/25 13:56:42 31S0K630_026

Page 27: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To remind you of the passenger’sfront airbag hazards, and thatchildren must be properly restrainedin the back seat, your car haswarning labels on the dashboard andon the driver’s and front passenger’svisors. Please read and follow theinstructions on these labels.

To remind you of the front airbaghazards, your car has warning labelson the driver’s and front passenger’svisors. Please read and follow theinstructions on these labels.

U.S. Models Canadian Models

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety24

00/12/25 13:56:56 31S0K630_027

Page 28: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Using this feature willprevent children from opening thedoors and accidentally falling out(see page ).

Usingthis feature will prevent childrenfrom playing with the windows,which could expose them tohazards or distract the driver (seepage ).

Many parents say they prefer to putan infant or small child in the frontpassenger seat so they can watch thechild, or because the child requiresattention.

Placing a child in the front seatexposes the child to hazards fromthe passenger’s front airbag, andpaying close attention to a childdistracts the driver from theimportant tasks of driving, placingboth of you at risk.

If a child requires physical attentionor frequent visual contact, westrongly recommend that anotheradult ride with the child in the backseat. The back seat is far safer for achild than the front.

Place the largest child in the frontseat, provided the child is largeenough to wear a seat beltproperly (see page ).

Move the vehicle seat as far to therear as possible (see page ).

Have the child sit upright and wellback in the seat (see page ).

Make sure the seat belt is properlypositioned and secured (see page

).

Your car has three seating positionsin the back seat where children canbe properly restrained.

If you ever have to carry more thanthree children in your car:

15

13

18

37

84

100

CONTINUED

Additional Safety PrecautionsIf a Child Requires CloseAttention

If You Must Drive with SeveralChildren Use childproof door locks to

prevent children from opening thedoors.

Use the main power windowswitch to prevent children fromopening the rear windows.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety 25

00/12/25 13:57:11 31S0K630_028

Page 29: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Leaving children withoutadult supervision is illegal in moststates and Canadian provinces,and can be very hazardous. Forexample, infants and smallchildren left in a vehicle on a hotday can die from heatstroke. Andchildren left alone with the key inthe ignition can accidentally setthe vehicle in motion, possiblyinjuring themselves or others.

The following pages give generalguidelines for selecting and installingchild seats for infants and smallchildren.

To provide proper protection, a childseat should meet threerequirements:

The child seat shouldmeet Federal Motor VehicleSafety Standard 213 (FMVSS 213)or Canadian Motor Vehicle SafetyStandard 213 (CMVSS 213). Lookfor the manufacturer’s statementof compliance on the box and seat.

Childrenwho play in cars can accidentallyget trapped inside the trunk.Teach your children not to play inor around cars. Know how tooperate the emergency trunkopener (U.S. models only) anddecide if your children should beshown how to use this feature (seepage ).

Even very youngchildren learn how to unlockvehicle doors, turn on the ignition,and open the trunk, which canlead to accidental injury or death.

86

Do not leave children alone in yourvehicle.

Selecting a Child Seat

The child seat should meet safetystandards.

Lock all doors and the trunk whenyour vehicle is not in use.

Keep car keys and remotetransmitters out of the reach ofchildren.

1.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

General Guidelines for UsingChild Seats

26

00/12/25 13:57:21 31S0K630_029

Page 30: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

Before purchasing a child seat, werecommend that parents test thechild seat in the specific vehicleseating position (or positions) wherethey intend to use the seat. If apreviously purchased child seat doesnot fit, you may need to buy adifferent one that will fit.

However, Acura is confident that oneor more child seat models can fit andbe properly installed in allrecommended seating positions inyour car.

Due to variations in the design ofchild seats, vehicle seats, and seatbelts, all child seats will not fit allvehicle seating positions.

A child who is toolarge for a rear-facing child seat, andwho can sit up without support,should be restrained in a forward-facing child seat. See page foradditional information on protectingsmall children.

Children up to about oneyear old should be restrained in arear-facing, reclining child seat. Onlya rear-facing seat provides theproper support to protect an infant’shead, neck, and back. See page

for additional information onprotecting infants.30

33

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

The child seat should fit thevehicle seating position (orpositions) where it will be used.

Small Children:The child seat should be of theproper type and size to fit the child.

Infants:

3.

2.

27

00/12/25 13:57:33 31S0K630_030

Page 31: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If a small child must ride in thefront, follow the instructionsprovided in this section.

This page briefly summarizes Acura’srecommendations on where to placerear-facing and forward-facing childseats in your car.

The passenger’s front airbaginflates with enough force to killor seriously injure an infant in arear-facing child seat.

A small child in a forward-facingchild seat is also at risk. If thevehicle seat is too far forward,or the child’s head is thrownforward during a collision, aninflating front airbag can kill orseriously injure the child.

Never in the front seat, dueto the front airbag hazard.

Not recommended,due to the front airbag hazard. If asmall child must ride in front,move the vehicle seat to the rear-most position and secure a front-facing child seat with the seat belt(see page ).

Recommended positions.Properly secure a rear-facing childseat (see page ).

Recommendedpositions. Properly secure a front-facing child seat (see page ).

34

30

33

Placing a Child Seat Front Passenger’s SeatInfants:

Small children:

Back SeatsInfants:

Small children:

Airbags Pose SeriousRisks to Children

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety28

00/12/25 13:57:47 31S0K630_031

Page 32: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

After selecting a proper child seat,and a good position to install the seat,there are three main steps ininstalling the seat:

When you are not using a child seat,either remove it and store it in a safeplace, or make sure it is properlysecured. An unsecured child seat canbe thrown around the car during acrash or sudden stop and injuresomeone.

Make sure the child is properlystrapped in the child seataccording to the child seat maker’sinstructions. A child who is notproperly secured in a child seatcan be thrown out of the seat in acrash and be seriously injured.

If the child seat is not secure, tryinstalling it in a different seatingposition, or use a different style ofchild seat that can be firmly securedin the desired seating position.

After installing a childseat, push and pull the seatforward and from side to side toverify that it is secure.

To provide security during normaldriving maneuvers as well as duringa collision, we recommend thatparents secure a child seat as firmlyas possible.

However, a child seat does not needto be ‘‘rock solid.’’ In some vehiclesor seating positions, it may bedifficult to install a child seat so thatit does not move at all. Some side-to-side or back-and-forth movement canbe expected and should not reducethe child seat’s effectiveness.

All child seats aredesigned to be secured to the carwith the lap part of a lap/shoulderbelt. Some child seats can besecured to the vehicle’s LATCHanchorage system. A child whoseseat is not properly secured to thecar can be endangered in a crash.See pages , and forinstructions on how to properlysecure child seats in this car.

31 35 42

Installing a Child Seat

Storing a Child Seat

Secure the child in the child seat.

Make sure the child seat is firmlysecured.

Properly secure the child seat tothe car.

1.

2.

3.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety 29

00/12/25 13:57:58 31S0K630_032

Page 33: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Only a rear-facing child seat providesproper support for a baby’s head,neck, and back. Infants up to aboutone year of age must be restrained ina rear-facing child seat.

In this car, a rear-facing child seatcan be placed in any seating positionin the back seat, but not in the frontseat.

We recommend that an infant berestrained in a rear-facing child seatuntil the infant reaches the seatmaker’s weight or height limit and isable to sit up without support.

Two types of seats may be used: aseat designed exclusively for infants,or a convertible seat used in the rear-facing, reclining mode.

If the passenger’sfront airbag inflates, it can hit theback of the child seat with enoughforce to kill or seriously injure aninfant. If an infant must be closelywatched, we recommend thatanother adult sit in the back seatwith the baby.

If placedfacing forward, an infant could bevery seriously injured during afrontal collision.

Protecting Infants

Child Seat Type

Rear-Facing Child Seat Placement

Never put a rear-facing child seat inthe front seat.

Do not put a rear-facing child seat ina forward-facing position.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety30

Placing a rear-facing child seatin the front seat can result inserious injury or death if thepassenger’s front airbag inflates.

Always place a rear-facing childseat in the back seat, not thefront.

00/12/25 13:58:11 31S0K630_033

Page 34: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

With the child seat in the desiredback seating position, route thebelt through the child seataccording to the seat maker’sinstructions, then insert the latchplate into the buckle.

The lap/shoulder belts in the backseats have a locking mechanism thatmust be activated to secure a childseat.

The following pages provideinstructions and tips on how tosecure a rear-facing child seat withthis type of seat belt.

When properly installed, a rear-facing child seat may prevent thedriver or a front-seat passenger frommoving the seat as far back asrecommended (see page ). Or itmay prevent them from locking theseat-back in the desired uprightposition (see page ).

In either case, we recommend thatyou place the child seat directlybehind the front passenger seat,move the front seat as far forward asneeded, and leave it unoccupied. Oryou may wish to get a smaller childseat that allows you to safely carry afront passenger.

If you have a child seat designed toattach to the vehicle’s LATCHanchorage system, follow theinstructions on page .

1.

14

13

42

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

Rear-Facing Child Seat Installation

31

00/12/25 13:58:21 31S0K630_034

Page 35: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Push and pull the child seatforward and from side to side toverify that it is secure enough tostay upright during normal drivingmaneuvers. If the child seat is notsecure, unlatch the belt, allow it toretract fully, then repeat thesesteps.

After confirming that the belt islocked, grab the shoulder part ofthe belt near the buckle and pullup to remove any slack from thelap part of the belt. Remember, ifthe lap part of the belt is not tight,the child seat will not be secure.To remove slack, it may help toput weight on the child seat, orpush on the back of the seat, whilepulling up on the belt.

To activate the lockable retractor,slowly pull the shoulder part of thebelt all the way out until it stops,then let the belt feed back into theretractor (you might hear aclicking noise as the belt retracts).

After the belt has retracted, tug onit. If the belt is locked, you will notbe able to pull it out. If you can pullthe belt out, it is not locked andyou will need to repeat these steps.

4. 5.2.

3.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety32

00/12/25 13:58:31 31S0K630_035

Page 36: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

For proper protection, an infant mustride in a reclined, or semi-reclinedposition. To determine the properreclining angle, check with the baby’sdoctor or follow the seat maker’srecommendations.

To achieve the desired recliningangle, it may help to put a rolled uptowel under the toe of the child seat,as shown.

To deactivate the lockingmechanism and remove a child seat,unlatch the buckle, unroute the seatbelt, and let the belt fully retract.

A child who can sit up withoutsupport, and who fits within the childseat maker’s weight and heightlimits, should be restrained in aforward-facing, upright child seat.

Of the different seats available, werecommend those that have a five-point harness system as shown.

CONTINUED

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

Rear-Facing Child Seat InstallationTips

Child Seat Type

Protecting Small Children

33

00/12/25 13:58:42 31S0K630_036

Page 37: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If it is necessary to put a forward-facing child seat in the front, movethe vehicle seat as far to the rear aspossible, be sure the child seat isfirmly secured to the car, and thechild is properly strapped in the seat.

We also recommend that a smallchild stay in the child seat as long aspossible, until the child reaches theweight or height limit for the seat.

In this car, the best place to install aforward-facing child seat is in one ofthe seating positions in the back seat.

If the vehicle seat istoo far forward, or the child’s head isthrown forward during a collision, aninflating front airbag can strike thechild with enough force to causevery serious or fatal injuries. If asmall child must be closely watched,we recommend that another adult sitin the back seat with the child.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

Child Seat Placement

Placing a forward-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag canbe hazardous.

34

Improperly placing a forward-facing child seat in the frontseat can result in serious injuryor death if the front airbagsinflate.

If you must place a forward-facing child seat in front, movethe vehicle seat as far back aspossible and properly restrainthe child.

00/12/25 13:58:51 31S0K630_037

Page 38: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

With the child seat in the desiredseating position, route the beltthrough the child seat accordingto the seat maker’s instructions,then insert the latch plate into thebuckle.

To activate the lockable retractor,slowly pull the shoulder part of thebelt all the way out until it stops,then let the belt feed back into theretractor (you might hear aclicking noise as the belt retracts).

After the belt has retracted, tug onit. If the belt is locked, you will notbe able to pull it out. If you can pullthe belt out, it is not locked andyou will need to repeat these steps.

The lap/shoulder belts in the backand front passenger seating positionshave a locking mechanism that mustbe activated to secure a child seat.

The following pages provideinstructions on how to secure aforward-facing child seat with thistype of seat belt.

If you have a child seat designed toattach to the vehicle’s LATCHanchorage system, follow theinstructions on page .

2.

3.

1.42

CONTINUED

Child Seat Installation

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety 35

00/12/25 13:59:02 31S0K630_038

Page 39: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

After confirming that the belt islocked, grab the shoulder part ofthe belt near the buckle and pullup to remove any slack from thelap part of the belt. Remember, ifthe lap part of the belt is not tight,the child seat will not be secure. Itmay help to put weight on thechild seat, or push on the back ofthe seat, while pulling up on thebelt.

Push and pull the child seatforward and from side to side toverify that it is secure enough tostay upright during normal drivingmaneuvers. If the child seat is notsecure, unlatch the belt, allow it toretract fully, then repeat thesesteps.

To deactivate the lockingmechanism in order to remove achild seat, unlatch the buckle,unroute the seat belt, and let the beltfully retract.

4. 5.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety36

00/12/25 13:59:09 31S0K630_039

Page 40: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

When a child reaches therecommended weight or height limitfor a forward-facing child seat, thechild should sit in the back seat andwear a lap/shoulder belt.

If a child is too short for the shoulderpart of the belt to properly fit, werecommend that the child use abooster seat until the child is tallenough to use the seat belt without abooster.

The following pages giveinstructions on how to check properseat belt fit, what kind of boosterseat to use if one is needed, andimportant precautions for a childwho must sit in the front seat.

To determine if a lap/shoulder beltproperly fits a child, have the childput on the seat belt. Follow theinstructions on page . Then checkhow the belt fits.

If the shoulder part of the belt restsover the child’s collarbone andagainst the center of the chest, asshown, the child is large enough towear the seat belt.

15

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

Protecting Larger Children Checking Seat Belt Fit

37

Allowing a larger child to sitimproperly in the front seat canresult in injury or death if thepassenger’s front airbag inflates.

If a larger child must sit in front,make sure the child moves theseat as far back as possibleand wears the seat belt properly.

00/12/25 13:59:20 31S0K630_040

Page 41: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

However, if the belt touches orcrosses the child’s neck, the childneeds to use a booster seat.

This could result inserious neck injuries during a crash.

This could causevery serious injuries during a crash.It also increases the chance that thechild will slide under the belt in acrash and be injured.

Devices intended to improveoccupant comfort or reposition theshoulder part of a seat belt, severelycompromise the protective capabilityof the seat belt and increase thechance of serious injury in a crash.

If they do, they couldbe very seriously injured in a crash.

If a child needs a booster seat, werecommend choosing a style thatallows the child to use the lap/shoulder belt directly, without ashield, as shown.

Whichever style you select, followthe booster seat maker’s instructions.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

Do not let a child wear a seat beltacross the neck.

Do not let a child put the shoulderpart of a seat belt behind the back orunder the arm.

Do not put any accessories on a seatbelt.

Two children should never use thesame seat belt.

Using a Booster Seat

38

00/12/25 13:59:31 31S0K630_041

Page 42: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

A child may continue using a boosterseat until the tops of the ears areeven with the top of the seat-back. Achild of this height should be tallenough to use the lap/shoulder beltwithout a booster.

The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that all childrenages 12 and under be properlyrestrained in a back seat.

The back seat is the safest place fora child of any age or size.

In addition, the passenger’s frontairbag poses serious risks to children.If the seat is too far forward, or thechild’s head is thrown forwardduring a collision, or the child isunrestrained or out of position, aninflating front airbag can kill orseriously injure the child.

The side airbag also poses risks. Ifany part of a larger child’s body is inthe path of a deploying airbag, thechild could receive possibly seriousinjuries.

Of course, children vary widely. Andwhile age may be one indicator ofwhen a child can safely ride in thefront, there are other importantfactors you should consider.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

When Can a Larger Child Sit in Front

39

00/12/25 13:59:41 31S0K630_042

Page 43: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Check that the child’s seat belt isproperly positioned and secured.

Supervise the child. Even maturechildren sometimes need to bereminded to fasten the seat beltsor sit properly.

Have the child sit up straight, backagainst the seat, and feet on ornear the floor.

Move the vehicle seat to the rear-most position.

Carefully read the owner’s manualand make sure you understand allseat belt instructions and all safetyinformation.

If you decide that a child can safelyride up front, be sure to:

To safely ride in front, a child mustbe able to follow the rules, includingsitting properly and wearing the seatbelt properly throughout a ride.

Physically, a child must be largeenough for the lap/shoulder belt toproperly fit over the hips, chest, andshoulder (see pages and ). Ifthe seat belt does not fit properly,the child should not sit in the front.

3715

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

MaturityPhysical Size

40

00/12/25 13:59:52 31S0K630_043

Page 44: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Your car has three tether anchoragepoints under the rear window forsecuring a tether-style child seat tothe car.

Since a tether can provide additionalsecurity, we recommend using atether whenever one is required oravailable.

The tether anchorage points arelocated under plastic covers. Pivotthe cover backward to access theanchorage point.

Attach the tether strap hook to thetether anchorage point as shown inthe illustration, then tighten thestrap according to the child seatmaker’s instructions.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

Using Child Seats with Tethers

41

00/12/25 14:00:02 31S0K630_044

Page 45: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Your car is equipped with LATCH(Lower Anchors and Tethers forChildren) at the outer rear seats.The lower anchors are locatedbetween the seat-back and seatbottom and are only to be used witha child seat designed for use withLATCH.

The exact location of each loweranchor is marked with a small circleabove the lower anchor point.

To install a LATCH-compatible childseat:

Move the seat belt buckle orcenter seat belt away from thelower anchor.

Make sure there are no foreignobjects around the anchor.Foreign objects could get in theway of a secure connectionbetween the child seat and theanchor.

Put the child seat in the rear leftor right vehicle seat and attach thechild seat to the lower anchoraccording to the child seat maker’sinstructions.

1.

2.

3.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

Using LATCH

42

RRiiggiidd ttyyppeeLLOOWWEERR AANNCCHHOORRSS

00/12/25 14:00:12 31S0K630_045

Page 46: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Follow the child seat maker’sinstructions for any additionaladvice on adjusting or tighteningthe fit.

Attach the tether strap hook to thetether anchorage point and tightenthe strap according to the childseat maker’s instructions.

Push and pull the child seatforward and from side to side toverify that it is secure enough tostay upright during normal drivingmaneuvers.

4. 5.

6.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety 43

FFlleexxiibbllee ttyyppee

00/12/25 14:00:20 31S0K630_046

Page 47: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

This seat belt has a single belt thatgoes over your shoulder, across yourchest and across your hips.

To unlock the belt, push the redPRESS button on the buckle.

To fasten the belt, insert the latchplate into the buckle, then tug on thebelt to make sure the buckle islatched.

Guide the belt across your body tothe door pillar. After exiting the car,be sure the belt is out of the way andwill not get closed in the door.

Your seat belt system includes lap/shoulder belts in all five seatingpositions. The front seat belts arealso equipped with automatic seatbelt tensioners.

The seat belt system alsoincludes a light on the

instrument panel to remind you andyour passengers to fasten your belts.If the driver’s seat belt is notfastened before the ignition is turnedON (II), the light will come on and abeeper will also sound. The beeperwill stop after a few seconds, but thelight will stay on until the driver’sseat belt is fastened.

All seat belts have an emergencylocking retractor. In normal driving,the retractor lets you move freely inyour seat while it keeps sometension on the belt. During a collisionor sudden stop, the retractorautomatically locks the belt to helprestrain your body.

The seat belts in all seating positionsexcept the driver’s have an additionallocking mechanism that must beactivated to secure a child seat. (Seepages and for instructions onhow to secure child seats with thistype of seat belt.)

31 35

Driver and Passenger Safety

Additional Information About Your Seat Belts

Seat Belt System Components Lap/Shoulder Belt

44

00/12/25 14:00:33 31S0K630_047

Page 48: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If the shoulder part of the belt ispulled all the way out, the lockingmechanism will activate. The beltwill retract, but it will not allow thepassenger to move freely.

To deactivate the lockingmechanism, unlatch the buckle andlet the seat belt fully retract. Torefasten the belt, pull it out only asfar as needed.

See page for instructions on howto wear the lap/shoulder beltproperly.

The tensioners are designed toactivate primarily in frontal collisions.The tensioners are independent ofthe airbag system, so they can beactivated during a collision that

might not cause the airbags todeploy. In this case, the airbagswould not be needed but theadditional seat belt tension can behelpful.

For added protection, the front seatbelts are equipped with automaticseat belt tensioners. When activated,the tensioners immediately tightenthe belts to help hold the driver anda front passenger in place.

The tensioners will be activated in acollision severe enough to cause thefront airbags to inflate.

When the tensioners are activated,the seat belts will remain tight untilthey are unbuckled in the normalway.

The SRS indicator light willcome on if there is a

problem with your automatic seatbelt tensioners (see page ).

15

50

Driver and Passenger Safety

Additional Information About Your Seat Belts

Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners

45

00/12/25 14:00:44 31S0K630_048

Page 49: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

For safety, you should check thecondition of your seat belts regularly.

Pull each belt out fully and look forfrays, cuts, burns, and wear. Checkthat the latches work smoothly andthat the lap/shoulder belts retracteasily. Any belt not in good conditionor not working properly will notprovide good protection and shouldbe replaced as soon as possible.

Acura provides a lifetime warrantyon seat belts. Acura will repair orreplace any seat belt componentthat fails to function properlyduring normal use. Please seeyourbooklet for details.

If a seat belt is worn during a crash,you should have your dealer replacethe seat belt. A belt that has beenworn during a crash may not providethe same level of protection in asubsequent crash. The dealer shouldalso inspect the anchors for damageand replace them if needed.

Automatic seat belt tensioners thatdeployed during a crash must bereplaced.

For information on how to clean yourseat belts, see page .273

Acura Warranty Information

Driver and Passenger Safety

Additional Information About Your Seat Belts

Seat Belt Maintenance

U.S. Models

46

Not checking or maintainingseat belts can result in seriousinjury or death if the seat beltsdo not work properly whenneeded.

Check your seat belts regularlyand have any problemcorrected as soon as possible.

00/12/25 14:00:55 31S0K630_049

Page 50: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Your Supplemental Restraint System(SRS) includes:

An indicator light on theinstrument panel that alerts you toa possible problem with thesystem (see page ).

Two front airbags. The driver’sairbag is stored in the center ofthe steering wheel; the frontpassenger’s airbag is stored in thedashboard. Both are marked ‘‘SRSAIRBAG.’’

Emergency backup power in caseyour car’s electrical system isdisconnected in a crash.

If you ever have a moderate tosevere frontal collision, the sensorswill detect the vehicle’s rapiddeceleration. If the rate ofdeceleration is high enough, thecontrol unit will instantly inflate thefront airbags.

A sophisticated electronic systemthat continually monitors andrecords information about thesensors, the control unit, theairbag activators, and driver andpassenger seat belt use when theignition is ON (II).

Sensors that can detect amoderate to severe frontalcollision.

Automatic seat belt tensioners(see page ).45

50

CONTINUED

SRS Components How Your Front Airbags Work

Driver and Passenger Safety

Additional Information About Your Airbags

47

00/12/25 14:01:08 31S0K630_050

Page 51: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The total time for inflation anddeflation is approximately one-tenthof a second, so fast that mostoccupants are not aware that theairbags deployed until they see themlying in their laps.

After a crash, you may see whatlooks like smoke. This is actuallypowder from the airbag’s surface.Although the powder is not harmful,people with respiratory problemsmay experience some temporarydiscomfort. If this occurs, get out ofthe car as soon as it is safe to do so.

For additional information on howyour airbags work, see the booklettitled

that came with yourowner’s manual.

Since both airbags use the samesensors, both airbags normallyinflate at the same time. However, itis possible for only one airbag toinflate.

This can occur when the severity ofa collision is at the margin, orthreshold, that determines whetheror not the airbags will deploy. Insuch cases, the seat belt will providesufficient protection, and thesupplemental protection offered bythe airbag would be minimal.

After inflating, the front airbagsimmediately deflate, so they won’tinterfere with the driver’s visibility,or the ability to steer or operateother controls.

For additional information on howyour airbags work, ask your dealerfor a copy of the booklet titled

During a frontal crash, your seatbelts help restrain your lower bodyand torso. Your airbag provides acushion to help restrain and protectyour head and chest.

SRS: What You Need to KnowAbout Airbags

SRS:What You Need to Know About Airbags.

U.S. Owners

Canadian Owners

Driver and Passenger Safety

Additional Information About Your Airbags

48

00/12/25 14:01:18 31S0K630_051

Page 52: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To get the best protection from theside airbags, front seat occupantsshould wear their seat belts and situpright and well back in their seats.

Your car is equipped with sideairbags for the driver and a frontseat passenger. The airbags arestored in the outer edges of the frontseat-backs, and both are marked‘‘SIDE AIRBAG.’’

If you ever have a moderate tosevere side impact, the sensors willdetect rapid deceleration and signalthe control unit to instantly inflateeither the driver’s or the passenger’sside airbag.

Only one airbag will deploy during aside impact. If the impact is on thepassenger’s side, the passenger’sside airbag will deploy even if thereis no passenger.

How Your Side Airbags Work

Driver and Passenger Safety

Additional Information About Your Airbags

49

00/12/25 14:01:26 31S0K630_052

Page 53: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If the SRS indicator light does notcome on after you turn the ignitionON (II).

If the light stays on after theengine starts.

If the light comes on or flashes onand off while you drive.

If the light comes on at any othertime, or does not come on at all, youshould have the system checked byyour dealer. For example:

When you turn the ignition ON (II),this indicator will light briefly thengo out. This tells you that the systemis working properly.

The purpose of the SRSindicator light is to alert

you to a potential problem with yourfront airbags. This light will alsoalert you to a potential problem withyour automatic seat belt tensioners(page ); or your side airbags orpassenger’s side airbag automaticcutoff system (page ).

If you see any of these indications,your front or side airbags may notdeploy, your passenger’s side airbagautomatic cutoff system may notwork properly, or your seat belttensioners may not work when youneed them. See your Acura dealer assoon as possible.

49

45

How the SRS Indicator LightWorks

Additional Information About Your Airbags

Driver and Passenger Safety50

Ignoring the SRS indicator lightcan result in serious injury ordeath if the airbags, cutoffsystem, or tensioners do notwork properly.

Have your vehicle checked by adealer as soon as possible ifthe SRS light alerts you to apotential problem.

00/12/25 14:01:36 31S0K630_053

Page 54: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

This light alerts you thatthe passenger’s side airbag

has been automatically shut off.

To reduce the risk of injury from aninflating side airbag, your car has anautomatic cutoff system for thepassenger’s side airbag.

Although Acura does not encouragechildren to ride in the front seat, thissystem is designed to shut off theside airbag if a child leans sidewaysand the child’s head is in the sideairbag deployment path.

If a small-statured adult leanssideways, or larger adult slouchesand leans sideways into thedeployment path of the side airbag,the system may also shut off the sideairbag.

A front seat passenger should notuse a cushion or other object as abackrest. It may prevent the cutoffsystem from working properly.

When you turn the ignition ON (II),the indicator should light briefly andgo out (see page ). If it doesn’tlight, stays on, or comes on whiledriving without a passenger in thefront seat, have the system checked.

If the side airbag off indicator lightcomes on, you should have thepassenger sit upright. Once thepassenger is out of the deploymentpath of the side airbag, the systemwill turn the airbag back on and thelight will go out.

60

Driver and Passenger Safety

Additional Information About Your Airbags

How The Side Airbag OffIndicator Light Works

51

00/12/25 14:01:47 31S0K630_054

Page 55: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Your front and side airbag systemsare virtually maintenance-free, andthere are no parts you can safelyservice. However, you must haveyour car serviced if:

Together, airbags andseat belts provide the bestprotection.

Tampering could causethe airbags to deploy, possiblycausing very serious injury.

See page for further informationand precautions relating to yourairbags.

Improperlyreplacing or covering front seat-back covers can prevent your sideairbags from inflating during acollision.

If rain or spilled watersoaks into a seat-back, it canprevent the side airbag systemfrom working properly.

Anyairbag that has deployed must bereplaced along with the controlunit and other related parts. Donot try to remove or replace anyairbag by yourself. This must bedone by an Acura dealer or aknowledgeable body shop.

Take your car to anauthorized Acura dealer as soon aspossible. If you ignore thisindication, the airbags might notinflate when you need them.

172

Additional Information About Your Airbags

Airbag Service Additional Safety PrecautionsDo not attempt to deactivate yourairbags.

Do not tamper with airbagcomponents or wiring for anyreason.

Do not cover or replace front seat-back covers without consulting anAcura dealer.

Do not expose the front seat-backsto water.

Your airbags ever inflate.

The SRS indicator light alerts youto a problem.

Driver and Passenger Safety52

00/12/25 14:01:59 31S0K630_055

Page 56: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

High levels of carbon monoxide cancollect rapidly in enclosed areas,such as a garage. Do not run theengine with the garage door closed.Even with the door open, run theengine only long enough to move thevehicle out of the garage.

Have the exhaust system inspectedfor leaks whenever:

With the trunk lid open, air flow canpull exhaust gas into your car’sinterior and create a hazardouscondition. If you must drive with thetrunk lid open, open all the windowsand set the climate control system asshown below.

If you must sit in your parked car,even in an unconfined area, with theengine running, adjust the climatecontrol system as follows:

Your car’s exhaust contains carbonmonoxide gas. You should have noproblem with carbon monoxideentering the car in normal driving ifyou maintain your car properly.

The car is raised for an oil change.You notice a change in the soundof the exhaust.The car was in an accident thatmay have damaged the underside. Select the Fresh Air mode.

Select the mode.Set the fan speed to high.Set the temperature control to acomfortable setting.

1.2.3.4.

Carbon Monoxide Hazard

Driver and Passenger Safety 53

Carbon monoxide gas is toxic.Breathing it can causeunconsciousness and even killyou.

Avoid any enclosed areas oractivities that expose you tocarbon monoxide.

00/12/25 14:02:09 31S0K630_056

Page 57: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

These labels are in the locationsshown. They warn you of potentialhazards that could cause seriousinjury. Read these labels carefully.

If a label comes off or becomes hardto read, contact your Acura dealerfor a replacement.

U.S. models only

U.S. models

Canadian models

Safety Labels

Driver and Passenger Safety54

HOOD RADIATOR CAP

SUN VISOR

DASHBOARD

00/12/25 14:02:28 31S0K630_057

Page 58: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

This section gives information aboutthe controls and displays thatcontribute to the daily operation ofyour Acura. All the essential controlsare within easy reach.

...........................Control Locations . 56...............................Indicator Lights . 57

.............................................Gauges . 64...............................Speedometer . 64

.................................Tachometer . 64.....................................Odometer . 65...................................Trip Meter . 65

Outside Temperature...................................Indicator . 66

...................Temperature Gauge . 66..................................Fuel Gauge . 66

Maintenance Required...................................Indicator . 67

Controls Near the Steering.......................................Wheel . 68

...................................Headlights . 69

...................................Fog Lights . 70Automatic Lighting Off

.....................................Feature . 70............Daytime Running Lights . 70

....Instrument Panel Brightness . 71................................Turn Signals . 71

.....................Windshield Wipers . 72..................Windshield Washers . 73

..........................Hazard Warning . 73.............Rear Window Defogger . 74

......Steering Wheel Adjustment . 75...............................Keys and Locks . 76

..............................................Keys . 76....................Immobilizer System . 77

............................Ignition Switch . 78......................Power Door Locks . 79

...................Remote Transmitter . 81..............Childproof Door Locks . 84

...........................................Trunk . 85........Emergency Trunk Opener . 86

....................................Glove Box . 87............................Seat Adjustments . 88

Driver’s Seat Full Power............................Adjustments . 88

...........Driver’s Lumbar Support . 90

Front Passenger’s Seat............................Adjustments . 90..........................Head Restraints . 91

........................................Armrest . 92.............................................Mirrors . 94

....Adjusting the Power Mirrors . 94Driving Position Memory

..........................................System . 96....................................Seat Heaters . 99

............................Power Windows . 100.......................................Moonroof . 103

...............................Parking Brake . 104..................................Digital Clock . 105

.................Console Compartment . 106........................................Coin Box . 106

Armrest Storage..........................Compartments . 107...........................Beverage Holder . 108

........................................Sun Visor . 109................................Vanity Mirror . 109

........................Sunglasses Holder . 110............Accessory Power Sockets . 110

...............................Interior Lights . 111..................................Storage Tray . 112

Instruments and Controls

Instruments and Controls 55

00/12/25 14:02:33 31S0K630_058

Page 59: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Control Locations

Instruments and Controls56

PPOOWWEERR DDOOOORR LLOOCCKKSS

PPOOWWEERR WWIINNDDOOWWSSWWIITTCCHHEESS

TTRRUUNNKK RREELLEEAASSEEBBUUTTTTOONN

HHOOOODD RREELLEEAASSEEHHAANNDDLLEE

MMIIRRRROORRCCOONNTTRROOLLSS

AAUUDDIIOO SSYYSSTTEEMM

FFUUEELL FFIILLLL DDOOOORRRREELLEEAASSEE HHAANNDDLLEE

CCLLIIMMAATTEE CCOONNTTRROOLLSSYYSSTTEEMM

DDIIGGIITTAALL CCLLOOCCKK

((PP..116666))((PP..116655))

DDRRIIVVIINNGG PPOOSSIITTIIOONNMMEEMMOORRYY((PP..9966))

((PP..7799))

((PP..110000))

((PP..8855))

((PP..9944))((PP..110055))

((PP..111166,, 112233))

((PP..112299))

00/12/25 14:02:40 31S0K630_059

Page 60: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

**

**

The U.S. instrument panel is shown. Differences for the Canadian models are noted in the text.

Indicator Lights

Instruments and Controls

PPrreemmiiuumm mmooddeell

57

MMAALLFFUUNNCCTTIIOONN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR LLAAMMPP

LLOOWW OOIILL PPRREESSSSUURREEIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

CCHHAARRGGIINNGG SSYYSSTTEEMMIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

TTRRAACCTTIIOONN CCOONNTTRROOLLSSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

DDOOOORR AANNDD TTRRUUNNKKOOPPEENN MMOONNIITTOORR

HHIIGGHH BBEEAAMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

CCRRUUIISSEE CCOONNTTRROOLL IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

SSUUPPPPLLEEMMEENNTTAALL RREESSTTRRAAIINNTTSSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

IIMMMMOOBBIILLIIZZEERRSSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

AANNTTII--LLOOCCKKBBRRAAKKEE SSYYSSTTEEMMIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

LLOOWW FFUUEELL IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

SSEEAATT BBEELLTT RREEMMIINNDDEERR LLIIGGHHTT

BBRRAAKKEE LLAAMMPP IINNDDIICCAATTOORR PPAARRKKIINNGG BBRRAAKKEE AANNDDBBRRAAKKEE SSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

((PP..229933))

((PP..5599,, 229911))

((PP..5599,, 229922))

((PP..6611))

((PP..6622))

((PP..6633))

((PP..5599))

((PP..6633))((PP..5599))

((PP..6600))

((PP..6600))

((PP..6633))

((PP..6600))

((PP..6633))

((PP..6622))

SSIIDDEE AAIIRRBBAAGG OOFFFFIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

00/12/25 14:02:49 31S0K630_060

Page 61: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

**

**

The U.S. instrument panel is shown. Differences for the Canadian models are noted in the text.

Indicator Lights

Instruments and Controls

TTyyppee SS

58

MMAALLFFUUNNCCTTIIOONN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR LLAAMMPP

LLOOWW OOIILL PPRREESSSSUURREEIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

CCHHAARRGGIINNGG SSYYSSTTEEMMIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

DDOOOORR AANNDD TTRRUUNNKKOOPPEENN MMOONNIITTOORR

SSUUPPPPLLEEMMEENNTTAALL RREESSTTRRAAIINNTTSSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

IIMMMMOOBBIILLIIZZEERRSSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

AANNTTII--LLOOCCKKBBRRAAKKEE SSYYSSTTEEMMIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

LLOOWW FFUUEELL IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

SSEEAATT BBEELLTT RREEMMIINNDDEERR LLIIGGHHTT

BBRRAAKKEE LLAAMMPP IINNDDIICCAATTOORR PPAARRKKIINNGG BBRRAAKKEE AANNDDBBRRAAKKEE SSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

((PP..229933))

((PP..5599,, 229911))

((PP..5599,, 229922))

((PP..6611))

((PP..6622))

((PP..6633))

((PP..5599))

((PP..6633))((PP..5599))

((PP..6600))

((PP..6600))

((PP..6633))

((PP..6600))((PP..6622))

((PP..6622))HHIIGGHH BBEEAAMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

VVSSAA AACCTTIIVVAATTIIOONN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

VVEEHHIICCLLEE SSTTAABBIILLIITTYY AASSSSIISSTTSSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

CCRRUUIISSEE CCOONNTTRROOLL IINNDDIICCAATTOORR((PP..6633))

SSIIDDEE AAIIRRBBAAGG OOFFFFIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

00/12/25 14:02:57 31S0K630_061

Page 62: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The engine can be severely damagedif this light flashes or stays on whenthe engine is running. For completeinformation, see page .

If this light comes on when theengine is running, the battery is notbeing charged. For completeinformation, see page .

See page .

If you do not fasten your seat belt,the beeper will stop after a fewseconds but the light stays on untilyou do. Both the light and the beeperstay off if you fasten your seat beltbefore turning on the ignition.

This indicator lights when you turnthe ignition switch ON (II). It is areminder to you and your passengersto protect yourselves by fasteningthe seat belts. A beeper also soundsif you have not fastened your seatbelt.

The instrument panel has manyindicators to give you importantinformation about your car.

This light has two functions:

This indicator comes on when youturn the ignition switch ON (II). Itis a reminder to check the parkingbrake. Driving with the parkingbrake not fully released candamage the brakes and tires.

If the indicator remains lit afteryou have fully released theparking brake while the engine isrunning, or if it comes on whiledriving, it can indicate a problemin the brake system. For completeinformation, see page .

1.

2.

291

292

293

295

Low Oil PressureIndicator

Charging SystemIndicator

Malfunction IndicatorLamp

Seat Belt Reminder LightParking Brake and Brake SystemIndicator

Indicator Lights

Instruments and Controls 59

CanadaU.S.

00/12/25 14:03:13 31S0K630_062

Page 63: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

This indicator lights when you turnthe ignition switch ON (II). If itcomes on at any other time, itindicates that the passenger’s sideairbag has automatically shut off.For complete information, see page

.

This light normally comes on for afew seconds when you turn theignition switch ON (II), and whenthe ignition switch is turned toSTART (III). If this light comes on atany other time, there is a problem inthe ABS. If this happens, take thecar to your dealer to have it checked.With the light on, your car still hasnormal braking ability but no anti-lock. For complete information, seepage .

This indicator lights when you turnthe ignition switch ON (II). If itcomes on at any other time, itindicates a potential problem withyour front airbags. This light willalso alert you to a potential problemwith your side airbags or passenger’sside airbag automatic cutoff system.For complete information, see page

.

191

50

51

Indicator Lights

Instruments and Controls

Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)Indicator

Supplemental RestraintSystem Indicator

Side Airbag Off Indicator

60

U.S. Canada

00/12/25 14:03:23 31S0K630_063

Page 64: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

This indicator has three functions:

It comes on as a reminder that youhave turned off the TractionControl System.

It flashes when the TCS isregulating wheelspin.

If it comes on and stays on whenthe Traction Control System is on,it indicates that there is a problemin the TCS.

This light also comes on when youturn the ignition ON (II) and goes offafter the engine starts. See page

for more information on theTCS.

This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch ON (II).

If this light comes on and stays on atany other time, or it does not comeon when you turn the ignition switchON (II), there is a problem with theVSA system. Take the car to yourdealer to have it checked. WithoutVSA, your car still has normaldriving ability, but will not have VSAtraction and stability enhancement.See page for more informationon the VSA system.

It comes on as a reminder that youhave turned off the VehicleStability Assist (VSA) system.

It flashes when VSA is active (seepage ).

It comes on along with the VSAsystem indicator if there is aproblem with the VSA system.

This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch ON (II). See page

for more information on theVSA system.

This indicator has three functions:

1.

2.

3.

193

1.

2.

3.

196

196

196

On Type S On Type SOn Premium model

Traction Control System(TCS) Indicator

Vehicle Stability Assist(VSA) System Indicator

VSA Activation Indicator

Indicator Lights

Instruments and Controls 61

00/12/25 14:03:40 31S0K630_064

Page 65: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Canadian models onlyThis indicator lights when you turnthe ignition switch to ON (II) withthe headlight switch off and theparking brake set. It should go off ifyou turn on the headlights or releasethe parking brake. If it comes on atany other time, it means there is aproblem with the DRL. There mayalso be a problem with the highbeam headlights.

This light comes on with the highbeam headlights. See page forinformation on the headlightcontrols.

On Canadian models, this indicatorcomes on with reduced brightnesswhen the Daytime Running Lights(DRL) are on (see page ).

The left or right turn signal lightblinks when you signal a lane changeor turn. If the light does not blink orblinks rapidly, it usually means oneof the turn signal bulbs is burned out(see page ). Replace the bulb assoon as possible, since other driverscannot see that you are signalling.

The appropriate light comes on inthis display if the trunk or any dooris not closed tightly.

When you turn on the HazardWarning switch, both turn signallights blink. All turn signals on theoutside of the car should flash.

All the lights in the monitor displaycome on for a few seconds when youturn the ignition switch ON (II).

260

69

70

Indicator Lights

Instruments and Controls

‘‘Daytime RunningLights’’ Indicator

High Beam Indicator

Turn Signal andHazard WarningIndicators

Door and Trunk Open Monitor

62

00/12/25 14:03:53 31S0K630_065

Page 66: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Canadian models onlyThis light comes on when thewasher fluid level is low. Add washerfluid when you see this light come on(see page ).

This indicator comes on for a fewseconds when you turn the ignitionswitch ON (II). It will then go off ifyou have inserted a properly-codedignition key. If it is not a properly-coded key, the indicator will blinkand the engine will not start (seepage ).

This indicator also blinks severaltimes when you turn the ignitionswitch from ON (II) to ACCESSORY(I) or LOCK (0).

This lights when you set the cruisecontrol. See page for informationon operating the cruise control.

This light comes on as a reminderthat you must refuel soon.

If a brake light does not work, theindicator comes on

when you push the brake pedal withthe ignition switch ON (II).

A burned out brake light is a hazardwhen drivers behind you cannot tellyou are braking. Have your brakelights repaired right away.

76

234

77

Indicator Lights

Instruments and Controls

Washer Level IndicatorImmobilizer SystemIndicator

Cruise Control Indicator

Low Fuel Indicator

Brake Lamp Indicator

63

BRAKE LAMP

00/12/25 14:04:09 31S0K630_066

Page 67: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

U.S. Models

Canadian Models

This shows your speed in miles perhour (mph). The smaller innernumbers are the speed in kilometersper hour (km/h).

This shows your speed in kilometersper hour (km/h). The smaller innernumbers are the speed in miles perhour (mph).

The tachometer shows the enginespeed in revolutions per minute(rpm). To protect the engine fromdamage, never drive with thetachometer needle in the red zone.

Gauges

Instruments and Controls

Speedometer

Tachometer

64

TTAACCHHOOMMEETTEERR

SSPPEEEEDDOOMMEETTEERR FFUUEELL GGAAUUGGEE

TTRRIIPP MMEETTEERR

MMAAIINNTTEENNAANNCCEERREEQQUUIIRREEDD IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

OOUUTTSSIIDDEE TTEEMMPPEERRAATTUURREE IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

OODDOOMMEETTEERR

TTEEMMPPEERRAATTUURREE GGAAUUGGEE

RREESSEETTBBUUTTTTOONN

SSEELLEECCTTBBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:04:21 31S0K630_067

Page 68: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The odometer shows the total dis-tance your car has been driven. Itmeasures miles in U.S. models andkilometers in Canadian models.It is illegal under U.S. federal law andCanadian provincial regulations todisconnect, reset, or alter theodometer with the intent to changethe number of miles or kilometersindicated.

To reset a trip meter, display it, andthen press and hold the Reset buttonuntil the number resets to ‘‘0.0’’.Both trip meters will reset if the car’sbattery goes dead or is disconnected.

The trip meter shows the number ofmiles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada)driven since you last reset it.

There are two trip meters: Trip Aand Trip B. Switch between thesedisplays by pressing the Selectbutton repeatedly. Each trip meterworks independently, so you cankeep track of two different distances.When you turn the ignition switchON (II), what you last selected isdisplayed.

Instruments and Controls

Gauges

Trip MeterOdometer

65

RREESSEETTBBUUTTTTOONN

SSEELLEECCTTBBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:04:29 31S0K630_068

Page 69: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

This shows how much fuel you have.It is most accurate when the car is onlevel ground. It may show slightlymore or less than the actual amountwhen you are driving on curvy orhilly roads.

The needle returns to the bottomafter you turn off the ignition. Thegauge shows the fuel level readingimmediately after you turn theignition switch back ON (II).

This shows the temperature of theengine’s coolant. During normaloperation, the pointer should risefrom the bottom white mark to aboutthe middle of the gauge. In severedriving conditions, such as very hotweather or a long period of uphilldriving, the pointer may rise to nearthe upper red mark. If it reaches thered (Hot) mark, pull safely to theside of the road. Turn to page forinstructions and precautions onchecking the engine’s coolingsystem.

This indicator displays the outsidetemperature in Fahrenheit in U.S.models, and in Centigrade inCanadian models.

The temperature sensor is located inthe front bumper. Therefore, thetemperature reading can be affectedby heat reflection from the road sur-face, engine heat, and the exhaustfrom the surrounding traffic. Thiscan cause the temperature readingnot to be correct when your speed isunder 19 mph (30 km/h).

In certain weather conditions,temperature readings near freezing(32°F, 0°C) could mean that ice isforming on the road surface.

289

Instruments and Controls

Gauges

Fuel GaugeTemperature GaugeOutside Temperature Indicator

66

00/12/25 14:04:40 31S0K630_069

Page 70: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Turn off the engine.

Press and hold the select and resetbuttons on the instrument panel,then turn the ignition switch ON(II).

Between 6,000 miles (9,600 km) and7,500 miles (12,000 km) thisindicator will light for two secondswhen you first turn the ignitionswitch ON (II), and then flash forten seconds.

If you exceed 7,500 miles (12,000km) without having the scheduledmaintenance performed, thisindicator will remain on as a constantreminder.

Your dealer will reset this indicatorafter completing the scheduledmaintenance. If this maintenance isdone by someone other than yourAcura dealer, reset the indicator asfollows.

For the first 6,000 miles (9,600 km)after the Maintenance RequiredIndicator is reset, it will come on fortwo seconds when you turn theignition switch ON (II).

This indicator reminds you that it istime to take your car in forscheduled maintenance.

Hold the buttons forapproximately ten seconds untilthe indicator resets.

Refer to the Maintenance Schedulesfor Normal and Severe DrivingConditions on pages .

1.

2.

3.

214 218

Gauges

Instruments and Controls

Maintenance Required Indicator

67

SSEELLEECCTT BBUUTTTTOONN

RREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONN

MMAAIINNTTEENNAANNCCEE RREEQQUUIIRREEDDIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

00/12/25 14:04:52 31S0K630_070

Page 71: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

**

The two levers on the steeringcolumn contain controls for drivingfeatures you use most often. The leftlever controls the turn signals,headlights, and high beams. Theright lever controls the windshieldwashers and wipers.

The tilt adjustment lever on theunderside of the steering columnallows you to tilt the steering wheel.

To use the horn, press the padaround the ‘‘A’’ logo.

The controls under the left air ventare for the fog lights, the moonroof,the cruise control and the VSA/TCS.

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls68

IINNSSTTRRUUMMEENNTT PPAANNEELLBBRRIIGGHHTTNNEESSSS

TTIILLTT AADDJJUUSSTTMMEENNTT HHAAZZAARRDD WWAARRNNIINNGG LLIIGGHHTTSS

HHOORRNNCCRRUUIISSEECCOONNTTRROOLL

RREEAARR WWIINNDDOOWWDDEEFFOOGGGGEERR

HHEEAADDLLIIGGHHTTSS//TTUURRNN SSIIGGNNAALLSS

WWIINNDDSSHHIIEELLDDWWIIPPEERRSS//WWAASSHHEERRSS

TTRRAACCTTIIOONNCCOONNTTRROOLL//VVEEHHIICCLLEESSTTAABBIILLIITTYY AASSSSIISSTTSSYYSSTTEEMM OONN//OOFFFFSSWWIITTCCHH

MMOOOONNRROOOOFF SSWWIITTCCHH

FFOOGG LLIIGGHHTTSS

00/12/25 14:05:01 31S0K630_071

Page 72: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If you leave the lights on with theignition switch in ACCESSORY (I)or LOCK (0), you will hear areminder chime when you open thedriver’s door.

To change between low beams andhigh beams, pull the turn signal leveruntil you hear a click, then let go.The blue high beam indicator willlight (see page ).

To flash the high beams, pull theturn signal lever back lightly, thenrelease it. The high beams will comeon and go off.

The high beams will stay on for aslong as you hold the lever back, nomatter what position the headlightswitch is in.

The rotating switch on the left levercontrols the lights. Turning thisswitch to the ‘‘ ’’ position turnson the parking lights, taillights,instrument panel lights, side-markerlights, and rear license plate lights.Turning the switch to the ‘‘ ’’position turns on the headlights.

62

Headlights

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls 69

00/12/25 14:05:10 31S0K630_072

Page 73: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The lights will turn on again whenyou unlock or open the driver’s door.If you unlock the door, but do notopen it within 15 seconds, the lightswill go off. With the driver’s dooropen, you will hear a lights-onreminder chime.

With the headlight switch off, thehigh beam headlights come on withreduced brightness when you turnthe ignition switch to ON (II) andrelease the parking brake. Theyremain on until you turn the ignitionoff, even if you set the parking brake.

The headlights revert to normaloperation when you turn them onwith the switch.

The Automatic Lighting Off featureturns off the headlights, and all otherexterior lights and the instrumentpanel lights within 15 seconds ofremoving the key from the ignitionswitch and closing the driver’s door.

This feature activates if you leavethe headlight switch in the ‘‘ ’’or ‘‘ ’’ position, remove the key,open, then close the driver’s door.

If you remove the key from theignition switch with the headlightswitch on, but do not open the doorand get out, the lights will turn offafter ten minutes.

Turn the fog lights on and off bypressing the button. The indicator inthe button lights to show the foglights are on.

You can use the fog lights only whenthe headlights are on low beam.They will go off when you turn theheadlights off or onto high beam.

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls

Daytime Running Lights(Canadian Models)

Automatic Lighting Off FeatureFog Lights

70

00/12/25 14:05:24 31S0K630_073

Page 74: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To signal a lane change, push lightlyon the turn signal lever in the properdirection and hold it. The lever willreturn to the center position as soonas you release it.

Signal a turn or lane change with thislever. Push down on the lever tosignal a left turn, and up to signal aright turn. If you push it up or downall the way, the turn signal continuesto blink even when you release thelever. It shuts off automatically asyou complete the turn.

The dial on the instrument panelcontrols the brightness of theinstrument panel lights. Turn the dialto adjust the brightness.

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls

Turn SignalsInstrument Panel Brightness

71

TTUURRNN SSIIGGNNAALL LLEEVVEERR

00/12/25 14:05:33 31S0K630_074

Page 75: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The right lever controls the wind-shield wipers and washers. Therotary switch at the end of the leverhas three positions:

INT: intermittent: low speed: high speed

You can vary how often the wiperssweep the windshield by turning theINT TIME ring next to the rotaryswitch.

If you turn the INT TIME ring to theshortest delay, the wipers willchange from intermittent to lowspeed operation when vehicle speedexceeds 12 mph (20 km/h).

In intermittent, the wipers operateevery few seconds. The sweepinterval will change slightly withspeed; getting shorter as you drivefaster. In low speed and high speed,the wipers run continuously.

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls

Windshield Wipers

72

00/12/25 14:05:41 31S0K630_075

Page 76: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To clean the windshield, pull back onthe wiper control lever. The washersspray until you release the lever. Thewipers run at low speed while you’repulling the lever, then complete onemore sweep of the windshield afteryou release it.

To operate the wipers in mist mode,push the control lever down. Thewipers run at high speed until yourelease the lever. This gives you aquick way to clear the windshield.

Push the red button to turn on thehazard warning lights (four-wayflashers). This causes all fouroutside turn signals and bothindicators in the instrument panel toflash. Use the hazard warning lightsif you need to park in a dangerousarea near heavy traffic, or if your caris disabled.

CONTINUED

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls

Hazard WarningWindshield Washers

73

CCaarrss wwiitthhoouutt nnaavviiggaattiioonn ssyysstteemm

00/12/25 14:05:51 31S0K630_076

Page 77: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Make sure the rear window is clearand you have good visibility beforestarting to drive.

The defogger and antenna wires onthe inside of the rear window can beaccidentally damaged. Whencleaning the glass, always wipe sideto side.

The rear window defogger will clearfog, frost, and thin ice from thewindow. Push the defogger button toturn it on and off. The light in thebutton lights to show the defogger ison. If you do not turn it off, thedefogger will shut itself off afterabout 15 minutes. It also shuts offwhen you turn off the ignition. Youhave to turn it on again when yourestart the car.

Rear Window Defogger

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls74

CCaarrss wwiitthhoouutt nnaavviiggaattiioonn ssyysstteemmCCaarrss wwiitthh nnaavviiggaattiioonn ssyysstteemm CCaarrss wwiitthh nnaavviiggaattiioonn ssyysstteemm

00/12/25 14:06:00 31S0K630_077

Page 78: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

See page for important safetyinformation about how to properlyposition the steering wheel.

18

Make any steering wheel adjustmentbefore you start driving.

To adjust the steering wheel upwardor downward:

Push the lever under the steeringcolumn all the way down.

Move the steering wheel to thedesired position, making sure thewheel points toward your chest,not toward your face. Make sureyou can see the instrument panelgauges and the indicator lights.

Push the lever up to lock thesteering wheel in that position.

Make sure you have securelylocked the steering wheel in placeby trying to move it up and down.

1.

2.

3.

4.

Steering Wheel Adjustment

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls 75

Adjusting the steering wheelposition while driving maycause you to lose control of thecar and be seriously injured in acrash.

Adjust the steering wheel onlywhen the car is stopped.

00/12/25 14:06:12 31S0K630_078

Page 79: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Do not drop the keys or set heavyobjects on them.

Keep the keys away from liquids.If they get wet, dry them immedi-ately with a soft cloth.

The keys do not contain batteries.Do not try to take them apart.

These keys contain electroniccircuits that are activated by theImmobilizer System. They will notwork to start the engine if thecircuits are damaged.

Protect the keys from directsunlight, high temperature, andhigh humidity.

Your car also comes with two remotetransmitters; see page for anexplanation of the operation.

Your car comes with two masterkeys and a valet key.The master key fits all the locks onyour car:• Ignition• Doors• Glove box• Trunk pass-through cover

You should have received a keynumber plate with your keys. Youwill need this key number if you everhave to get a lost key replaced. Keepthe plate stored in a safe place. If youneed to replace a key, use only anAcura-approved key blank.

The valet key works only in theignition and the door locks. You cankeep the trunk pass-through cover,and glove box locked when you leaveyour car and the valet key at aparking facility.

81

Keys

Remote Transmitter

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls76

VVAALLEETT KKEEYY((GGRREEYY))

MMAASSTTEERRKKEEYY((BBLLAACCKK))

KKEEYYNNUUMMBBEERRPPLLAATTEE

00/12/25 14:06:25 31S0K630_079

Page 80: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

This indicator will also blink severaltimes when you turn the ignitionswitch from ON (II) to ACCESSORY(I) or LOCK (0).

Do not attempt to alter this systemor add other devices to it. Electricalproblems could result that may makeyour car undriveable.

If you have lost your key and youcannot start the engine, contact yourAcura dealer.

The system may not recognize yourkey’s coding if another immobilizerkey or other metal object is near theignition switch when you insert thekey. To make sure the systemrecognizes the key code:

Do not keep other immobilizerkeys on the same key ring.

Use a plastic or leather key fob,not metal.

Keep other keys away from yourcar’s key and the ignition switchwhile trying to start the engine.

If the system repeatedly does notrecognize the coding of your key,contact your Acura dealer.

The Immobilizer System protectsyour car from theft. A properly-coded master or valet key must beused in the ignition switch for theengine to start. If an improperly-coded key (or other device) is used,the engine’s fuel system is disabled.

When you turn the ignition switch toON (II), the Immobilizer Systemindicator should come on for a fewseconds, then go out. If the indicatorstarts to blink, it means the systemdoes not recognize the coding of thekey. Turn the ignition switch toLOCK (0), remove the key, reinsertit, and turn the switch to ON (II)again.

CONTINUED

Immobilizer System

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls 77

00/12/25 14:06:35 31S0K630_080

Page 81: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

- You can insert orremove the key only in this position.To switch from ACCESSORY toLOCK, you must push the key inslightly as you turn it. The shift levermust also be in Park. The anti-theftlock will lock the steering columnwhen you remove the key.

If the front wheels are turned, theanti-theft lock may sometimes makeit difficult to turn the key fromLOCK to ACCESSORY. Firmly turnthe steering wheel to the left or tothe right as you turn the key.The ignition switch is on the right

side of the steering column. It hasfour positions:• LOCK (0)• ACCESSORY (I)• ON (II)• START (III)

As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.

Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.

This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.

LOCK (0)Ignition Switch

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls78

00/12/25 14:06:45 31S0K630_081

Page 82: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

This is the normal keyposition when driving. All featuresand accessories on the car are usable.Several of the lights on the instru-ment panel come on as a test whenyou turn the ignition switch fromACCESSORY to ON.

In this position,you can operate the audio systemand the accessory power sockets.

Use this positiononly to start the engine. The switchreturns to ON (II) when you let go ofthe key.

The engine will not start if theImmobilizer System does notrecognize the key’s coding (see page

).

You will hear a reminder beeper ifyou leave the key in the ignitionswitch in the LOCK (0) orACCESSORY (I) position and openthe driver’s door. Remove the key toturn off the beeper.

Each front door has a master doorlock switch. Either switch locks andunlocks all doors. Push the switchdown to lock all doors, and up tounlock them.

77

CONTINUED

ON (II)

ACCESSORY (I)

START (III)

Power Door Locks

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls 79

MMAASSTTEERR DDOOOORR LLOOCCKK SSWWIITTCCHH

00/12/25 14:06:56 31S0K630_082

Page 83: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If you forget and leave the key in theignition switch, Lockout Preventionwill not allow you to lock the driver’sdoor. With the driver’s door openand the key in the ignition, bothmaster door lock switches aredisabled. However, if the driver’sdoor is not open, the master doorlock switches are not disabled.Pushing the switch down on theopen passenger’s door will lock alldoors. If you try to lock an opendriver’s door by pushing in the locktab, the tabs on all doors pop out.Pushing in the lock tab on thepassenger’s door only locks that door.

Each door has a lock tab at the top ofthe door. When you push down thelock tab on the driver’s door, alldoors lock. Pulling up the lock tab onthe driver’s door only unlocks thatdoor. The lock tab on eachpassenger’s door only locks andunlocks that door.

To lock any passenger’s door whengetting out of the car, push the locktab down and close the door. To lockthe driver’s door, remove the keyfrom the ignition switch and pushthe lock tab down or push the masterswitch down, then close the door.

All doors can be locked from theoutside by using the key in eitherfront door. To unlock only the driver’sdoor from the outside, insert the keyin the driver’s door lock, turn the keyand release it. If you turn the keyand hold it, all doors will unlock. Allfour doors will unlock when youunlock the passenger’s door with thekey.

Lockout Prevention

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls80

00/12/25 14:07:03 31S0K630_083

Page 84: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

You can lock and unlock your carwith the remote transmitter. Whenyou push the LOCK button, all doorslock. The parking lights, side markerlights, and taillights flash once.

If you unlock the doors with theremote transmitter, but do not openany of the doors within 30 seconds,the doors automatically relock andthe security system sets.

You cannot lock or unlock the doorswith the remote transmitter if anydoor is not fully closed or the key isin the ignition switch.

When you push the LOCK button asecond time within 5 seconds afteryou have locked the doors, you willhear a beep to verify that the doorsare locked and the security systemhas set.

When you push the UNLOCK buttononce, only the driver’s door unlocks.The remaining doors unlock whenyou push the button a second time.The parking lights, side markerlights, taillights and license platelights flash twice, each time youpush the button.

The ceiling light (if the ceiling lightswitch is in the center position) willcome on when you press theUNLOCK button. If you do not openany door, the light stays on for about10 seconds, then fades out. If yourelock the doors with the remotetransmitter before 10 seconds haveelapsed, the light will go offimmediately.

To open the trunk, push the TrunkRelease button for approximatelyone second.

You can open the trunk with theremote transmitter regardless of theposition of the main switch in theglove box. The trunk will not open ifthe key is in the ignition switch.

CONTINUED

Remote Transmitter

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls 81

LLEEDD

UUNNLLOOCCKKBBUUTTTTOONN

LLOOCCKKBBUUTTTTOONN

PPAANNIICCBBUUTTTTOONN

TTRRUUNNKKRREELLEEAASSEEBBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:07:16 31S0K630_084

Page 85: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To turn it back on, repeat thisprocedure. The LED will come onfor one second to indicate thefeature has been turned on.

If the seat and mirrors are already inthe proper positions, you will hearthree beeps when you open the door.

The driving position memoryactivated (Memory 1, Memory 2) isshown on the back of eachtransmitter. Make sure you storeyour desired driving position in thememory that is activated by thetransmitter you normally carry.

You can turn off this driving positionmemory activation. Press and holdthe LOCK and UNLOCK buttons atthe same time. The LED in theremote transmitter will blink twice.Then release the buttons.

The remote transmitters will alsoactivate the Driving PositionMemory System (see page ).When you open the driver’s doorafter unlocking it with the remotetransmitter, you will hear a beep.The driver’s seat and outside mirrorsmove to the positions stored in thatmemory location. You will hear twobeeps when the movement iscomplete.

Panic mode allows you to remotelyactivate your car’s security system toattract attention. When activated, thehorn will sound, and the exteriorlights will flash, for about 30 seconds.To activate panic mode, press andhold the PANIC button for about twoseconds.

To cancel Panic mode before 30seconds, press any button on theremote transmitter. You can alsoturn the ignition switch to ON (II).

Panic mode will not activate if theignition switch is in the ON (II)position. 96

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls

Recalling a Memorized DrivingPosition

Panic Mode

82

WWiitthh MMeemmoorryy 11 WWiitthh MMeemmoorryy 22

00/12/25 14:07:28 31S0K630_085

Page 86: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Remove the old battery and note thepolarity. Make sure the polarity ofthe new battery is the same ( sidefacing up), then insert it in thetransmitter.

Snap the two halves of thetransmitter case back together.

To replace the battery, place a clothon the edge of the transmitter andremove the upper half by carefullyprying on the edge with a small flat-tip screwdriver.

When the remote transmitter’sbattery begins to get weak, it maytake several pushes on the button tolock or unlock the doors, and theLED will not light. Replace thebattery as soon as possible.

Battery type: CR2025

CONTINUED

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls

Replacing the Battery

83

BBAATTTTEERRYY

00/12/25 14:07:39 31S0K630_086

Page 87: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.

Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.

This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.

Avoid severe shock to the trans-mitter, such as dropping or throwingit. Also, protect it from extreme hotor cold temperatures.

Clean the transmitter case with asoft cloth. Do not use strongcleaners or solvents that could harmthe case. Immersing the transmitterin any liquid will harm the trans-mitter and cause it to not functionproperly.

If you lose a transmitter, you willneed to have the replacementprogrammed to your car’s system byyour Acura dealer. Any othertransmitters you have will also needto be reprogrammed.

The childproof door locks aredesigned to prevent children seatedin the rear from accidentally openingthe rear doors. Each rear door has alock lever near the edge. With thelever in the LOCK position, the doorcannot be opened from the insideregardless of the position of the locktab. To open the door, pull the locktab up and use the outside doorhandle.

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls

Transmitter Care Childproof Door Locks

84

LLEEVVEERR

00/12/25 14:07:51 31S0K630_087

Page 88: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To close the trunk, press down onthe trunk lid.

See page for cargo loading andweight limit information. Keep thetrunk lid closed at all times whiledriving to avoid damaging the lid,and to prevent exhaust gas fromgetting into the interior. See

on page .

Reach through the trunk pass-through and pull the trunk releasehandle.

You can open the trunk in threeways:

Press the trunk release button onthe driver’s door.

Press the trunk release button onthe remote transmitter.

173

53

CONTINUED

CarbonMonoxide Hazard

Trunk

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls 85

TTRRUUNNKK RREELLEEAASSEE HHAANNDDLLEETTRRUUNNKK RREELLEEAASSEE BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:08:03 31S0K630_088

Page 89: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

As a safety feature, your car has arelease lever on the trunk latch sothe trunk can be opened from theinside.

To open the trunk, push the releaselever to the left.

Lock the glove box with themaster key. Make sure the trunkpass-through cover is locked (seepage ).

Give the person the valet key.

Even if the trunk main switch isturned off, you can open the trunkwith the remote transmitter.

To protect items in the trunk whenyou need to give the key to someoneelse:

Disable the trunk release buttonon the driver’s door by turning offthe trunk main switch in the glovebox.

2.

3.

1.

93

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls

Emergency Trunk Opener

U.S. models only

86

EEMMEERRGGEENNCCYY TTRRUUNNKK OOPPEENNEERR

TTRRUUNNKK MMAAIINN SSWWIITTCCHH

00/12/25 14:08:14 31S0K630_089

Page 90: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Open the glove box by squeezing thehandle. Close it with a firm push.Lock or unlock the glove box withthe master key.

The glove box light comes on onlywhen the instrument panel lights areon.

Parents should decide if theirchildren should be shown how to usethis feature.

For more information about childsafety, see pages and .25 26

Glove Box

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls 87

GGLLOOVVEE BBOOXX

An open glove box can causeserious injury to your passengerin a crash, even if thepassenger is wearing the seatbelt.

Always keep the glove boxclosed while driving.

00/12/25 14:08:23 31S0K630_090

Page 91: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Pull up or push down on the front ofthe switch to move the seat bottom’sfront edge up or down. Pull up orpush down on the rear of the switchto move the rear of the seat bottomup or down.

Push the horizontal switch forwardor backward to move the seatforward or backward.

You can adjust the seat with theignition switch in any position. Makeall adjustments before you startdriving.

The two power seat adjustmentswitches are on the outside edge ofthe seat bottom. The horizontalswitch adjusts the seat bottom inseveral directions. The short verticalswitch adjusts the seat-back angle.

See pages for important safetyinformation and warnings about how toproperly position seats and seat-backs.

1413

Driver’s Seat Full PowerAdjustments

Seat Adjustments

Instruments and Controls88

00/12/25 14:08:32 31S0K630_091

Page 92: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Pull the center of the horizontalswitch up to raise the seat. Push itdown to lower the seat.

Adjust the seat-back angle bypushing the rear switch in thedirection you want to move.

The driver’s seat includes a memoryfeature. Two seat positions can bestored in separate memories. Youcan then select a memorized positionby pushing the appropriate memorybutton or using the remotetransmitter. Refer to page forhow to memorize and select seatpositions.

96

Seat Adjustments

Instruments and Controls 89

00/12/25 14:08:39 31S0K630_092

Page 93: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The seat adjustment switches are onthe outside edge of the seat bottom.Push the long horizontal switchforward or backward to move theseat bottom in that direction.

Adjust the seat-back angle bypushing the vertical switch in thedirection you want to move.

Vary the lumbar support by movingthe lever on the right side of theseat-back. Move the lever forward orbackward to adjust the lumbarsupport through its full range.

Make all seat adjustments beforeyou start driving.

You can adjust the seat with theignition switch in any position.

See pages for important safetyinformation and warnings about how toproperly position seats and seat-backs.

13 14

Driver’s Lumbar Support Front Passenger’s SeatAdjustments

Instruments and Controls

Seat Adjustments

90

00/12/25 14:08:51 31S0K630_093

Page 94: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To remove a head restraint forcleaning or repair, pull it up as far asit will go. Push the release buttonand pull the restraint out of the seat-back.

The front head restraints helpprotect you and your passenger fromwhiplash and other injuries. They aremost effective when you adjust themso the back of the occupant’s headrests against the center of therestraint. A taller person shouldadjust the restraint as high aspossible. The head restraints adjust for height

and tilt. You need both hands toadjust the restraint. Do not attemptto adjust it while driving. To raise it,pull upward. To lower the restraint,push the release button sidewaysand push the restraint down. Toadjust the tilt, pivot the headrestraint to the desired position.

See page for important safetyinformation and a warning about how toproperly position the head restraints.

15

Seat Adjustments

Instruments and Controls

Head Restraints

91

RREELLEEAASSEE BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/26 11:14:14 31S0K630_094

Page 95: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The rear seat armrest is located atthe center of the rear seat. Pivot itdown to use it.

Make sure the passengers’ hands orfingers are away from the armrestbefore moving it.

The lid of the console compartmentcan be used as an armrest by movingit forward and backward. Make surethe armrest is securely latched.

Instruments and Controls

Armrest

92

00/12/25 14:09:06 31S0K630_095

Page 96: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The pass-through cover can beopened from either side; it foldsforward onto the center armrest.Open the cover by sliding the knobdownward and pushing or pulling onthe cover. To close the cover, swingit up and push firmly on the top.Make sure it latches properly.

Make sure all items in the trunk andthose extending through the pass-through are secured.

For security, this cover can belocked and unlocked only with themaster key. To lock the cover, insertthe key and turn it clockwise.

Never drive with this cover open andthe trunk lid open.See onpage .53

Instruments and Controls

Trunk Pass-through Cover

Carbon Monoxide Hazard

Armrest

93

KKNNOOBB

CCOOVVEERR

00/12/25 14:09:15 31S0K630_096

Page 97: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Adjust the outside mirrors with theadjustment switch on the driver’sdoor armrest:

Turn the ignition switch ON (II).

Move the selector switch to L(driver’s side) or R (passenger’sside).

Keep the inside and outside mirrorsclean and adjusted for best visibility.Be sure to adjust the mirrors beforeyou start driving.

The inside mirror can automaticallydarken to reduce glare. To turn onthis feature, press the button on thebottom of the mirror. The AUTOindicator comes on as a reminder.When it is on, the mirror darkenswhen it senses the headlights of avehicle behind you, then returns tonormal visibility when the lights aregone. Press the button again to turnoff this sensing.

1.

2.

Instruments and Controls

Mirrors

Adjusting the Power Mirrors

94

SSEELLEECCTTOORR SSWWIITTCCHH

SSEENNSSOORR IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

AAUUTTOO BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/26 11:14:23 31S0K630_097

Page 98: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Push the appropriate edge of theadjustment switch to move themirror right, left, up, or down.

When you finish, move theselector switch to the center (off)position. This turns off theadjustment switch so you can’tmove a mirror out of position byaccidentally bumping the switch.

With the selector switch in thecenter (off) position, the passenger’sside mirror will pivot downwardslightly when you shift thetransmission into reverse. This willgive you a better view of that side ofthe vehicle while parallel parking.The mirror returns to its originalposition when you take thetransmission out of reverse.

Outside mirror positions can bestored in the driving positionmemory system (see page ).

The outside mirrors are heated to re-move fog and frost. With the ignitionswitch ON (II), turn on the heatersby pressing the button. The light inthe button comes on as a reminder.Press the button again to turn theheaters off.

3.

4.

96

Mirrors

Instruments and Controls 95

AADDJJUUSSTTMMEENNTT SSWWIITTCCHH

HHEEAATTEEDD MMIIRRRROORR BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:09:34 31S0K630_098

Page 99: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Turn the ignition switch ON (II).You cannot add a new drivingposition in the memory unless theignition switch is ON (II). You canrecall a memorized position withthe ignition switch in any position.

Store a driving position as explainedin this section only when the car isparked.

Your Acura has a memory featurefor the driver’s seat and outsidemirror positions.

Two seat and outside mirrorpositions, for different drivers ordriving conditions, can be stored inseparate memories. You select amemorized position by pushing theappropriate button or using theappropriate remote transmitter(Memory 1 or Memory 2).

Adjust the seat to a comfortableposition (see page ).Adjust the outside mirrors for bestvisibility (see page ).

Press and release the MEMObutton on the control panel. Youwill hear a beep. Immediatelypress and hold one of the memorybuttons (1 or 2) until you hear twobeeps. The indicator light in thememory button will come on. Thecurrent positions of the driver’sseat and outside mirrors are nowstored.

3.

1.

2.88

94

Storing a Driving Position in Memory

Driving Position Memory System

Instruments and Controls96

MMEEMMOO BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:09:46 31S0K630_099

Page 100: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Not pressing a memory buttonwithin 5 seconds.

You can select memorized positionsas follows.

Make sure the parking brake is setand the shift lever is in Park.

Doing any of the following afterpressing the MEMO button willcancel the storing procedure.

Readjusting the seat position.

Readjusting the outside mirrorposition.

Each memory button stores only onedriving position. Storing a newposition erases the previous settingstored in that button’s memory. Ifyou want to add a new position whileretaining the current one, use theother memory button.

All stored driving positions will belost if your car’s battery goes dead oris disconnected.

Press the desired memory button(1 or 2) until you hear a beep, thenrelease the button.

The system will move the seat andoutside mirrors to the memorizedpositions. The indicator light in theselected memory button will flashduring movement. When theadjustments are complete, you willhear two beeps and the indicatorlight will remain on.

1.

2.

CONTINUED

Selecting a Memorized Position

Driving Position Memory System

Instruments and Controls 97

MMEEMMOORRYY BBUUTTTTOONNSS

00/12/25 14:09:59 31S0K630_100

Page 101: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To stop the system’s automatic ad-justment;

If desired, you can use theadjustment switches to change thepositions of the seat or outsidemirrors after they are in theirmemorized position. If you changethe memorized position, theindicator light in the memory buttonwill go out. To keep this drivingposition for later use, you must storeit in the driving position memory.

Press any button on the controlpanel: MEMO, 1 or 2.Push any of the adjustmentswitches for the seat.Shift out of Park.Adjust the outside mirrors.

Instruments and Controls

Driving Position Memory System

98

00/12/25 14:10:07 31S0K630_101

Page 102: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The HI or LO indicator lights andremains lit until you turn it off bypushing the opposite side of theswitch lightly. The indicator will turnoff.

In HI, the heater turns off when theseat gets warm, and turns back onafter the seat’s temperature drops. Itcontinues to cycle as long as youleave it set on HI. The HI indicatorremains lit as a reminder that youhave the heater on.

In LO, the heater runs continuously.It does not cycle with temperaturechanges.

Both front seats are equipped withseat heaters. The ignition switchmust be ON (II) to use them. Pushthe front of the switch, HI, to rapidlyheat up the seat. After the seatreaches a comfortable temperature,select LO by pushing the back of theswitch. This will keep the seat warm.

Follow these precautions wheneveryou use the seat heaters:

Do not use the seat heaters, evenon the LO setting, if the engine isleft idling for an extended period.They can weaken the battery,causing hard starting.

Use the HI setting only to heat theseats quickly. Select the LOsetting when the seats feel warm.The HI setting draws largeamounts of current from thebattery.

Because of the sensors for the sideairbag system, there is no heater inthe passenger’s seat-back.

Seat Heaters

Instruments and Controls 99

SSEEAATT HHEEAATTEERRSS

00/12/25 14:10:17 31S0K630_102

Page 103: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The driver’s door armrest has amaster power window control panel.To open any of the passengers’ win-dows, push down on the appropriateswitch and hold it down until thewindow reaches the desired position.To close the window, pull back onthe window switch. Release theswitch when the window gets to theposition you want.

Your car’s windows are electrically-powered. Turn the ignition switch toON (II) to raise or lower any window.

Each door has a switch that controlsits window. To open the window,push the switch down and hold it.Release the switch when you wantthe window to stop. Close thewindow by pulling back on theswitch and holding it.

Power Windows

Instruments and Controls100

DDRRIIVVEERR’’SS WWIINNDDOOWWSSWWIITTCCHH

MMAAIINNSSWWIITTCCHH

Closing a power window onsomeone’s hands or fingers cancause serious injury.

Make sure your passengers areaway from the windows beforeclosing them.

00/12/25 14:10:25 31S0K630_103

Page 104: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The master control panel also con-tains these extra features:

The MAIN switch controls power tothe passengers’windows. With thisswitch off, the passengers’windowscannot be raised or lowered. TheMAIN switch does not affect the driv-er’s window. Keep the MAIN switchoff when you have children in the carso they do not injure themselves byoperating the windows unintentional-ly. The lights inside the switchescome on when you turn the parkinglights or headlights on.

To open the driver’swindow fully, push the windowswitch firmly down, then release it.The window automatically goesdown all the way. To stop thewindow from going all the way down,pull back on the window switchbriefly.

To close the driver’s window fully,pull back the window switch firmly,then release it. The windowautomatically goes all the way up. Tostop the window from going all theway up, push down on the windowswitch briefly.

To open or close the driver’s windowpartially, push down or pull back onthe window switch lightly and hold it.The window will stop when yourelease the switch.

If the driver’s window runs into anyobstacle while it is closingautomatically, it will stop, and thenreverse direction. To close thewindow, remove the obstacle, thenuse the window switch again.

Auto reverse stops sensing when thewindow is almost closed. You shouldalways check that all passengers andobjects are away from the windowbefore closing it.

CONTINUED

Power Windows

Instruments and Controls

AUTO

Auto Reverse

101

00/12/25 14:10:35 31S0K630_104

Page 105: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The power window system has a key-off delay function. The windows willstill operate for up to ten minutesafter you turn off the ignition.Opening either front door cancelsthe delay function. You must turnthe ignition switch ON (II) againbefore you can raise or lower thewindows.

If your car’s battery is disconnectedor goes dead, or the driver’s windowfuse is removed, the AUTO functionwill be disabled. The power windowsystem needs to be reset afterreconnecting the battery or installingthe fuse. You should do the following.

Start the engine. Push down onthe driver’s window switch untilthe window is fully open.

Pull back on the driver’s windowswitch to close the windowcompletely, then hold the switchfor a second or two more.

If the power windows do not operateproperly after resetting, have yourcar checked by an Acura dealer.

1.

2.

Power Windows

Instruments and Controls102

00/12/25 14:10:43 31S0K630_105

Page 106: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The moonroof has a key-off delay.You can still open and close themoonroof for up to ten minutes afteryou turn off the ignition. The key-offdelay cancels as soon as you openeither front door. You must thenturn the ignition ON (II) for themoonroof to operate.

To tilt up the back of the moonroof,press and hold the center button( ). To close the moonroof,press and hold the top of the switch( ). To open the moonroof,press and hold the bottom of theswitch ( ). Release the switchwhen the moonroof gets to thedesired position. Make sureeveryone’s hands are away from themoonroof before opening or closingit.

The moonroof has two positions: itcan be tilted up in the back forventilation, or it can be slid back intothe roof. Use the switch under theleft dashboard vent to operate themoonroof. The ignition switch mustbe ON (II).

Instruments and Controls

Moonroof

103

MMOOOONNRROOOOFF SSWWIITTCCHH

Closing the moonroof onsomeone’s hands or fingers cancause serious injury.

Make sure all hands and fingersare clear of the moonroofbefore closing it.

If you try to open the moonroof inbelow-f reezing temperatures, or whenit is covered with snow or ice, you candamage the moonroof panel or motor.

00/12/25 14:10:52 31S0K630_106

Page 107: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To apply the parking brake, push theparking brake pedal down with yourfoot. To release the parking brake,push on the pedal again. The parkingbrake light on the instrument panelshould go out when the parkingbrake is fully released with theengine running. (see page .)59

Instruments and Controls

Parking Brake

104

PPAARRKKIINNGG BBRRAAKKEE PPEEDDAALL

Driving the car with the parking brakeapplied can damage the rear brakesand axles.

00/12/25 14:10:57 31S0K630_107

Page 108: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

You can use R to quickly set the timeto the nearest hour. If the displayedtime is before the half hour, pressingR sets the clock back to the previoushour. If the displayed time is afterthe half hour, pressing R sets theclock forward to the beginning of thenext hour.For example:

1:06 would RESET to 1:00.1:52 would RESET to 2:00.

To set the clock:

Press and hold the H button untilthe hour advances to the desiredtime.

Press and hold the M button untilthe numbers advance to thedesired time.

The digital clock displays the timewith the ignition switch in anyposition.

1.

2.

Cars without Navigation System

Digital Clock

Instruments and Controls 105

RRMMHH

00/12/25 14:11:08 31S0K630_108

Page 109: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The coin box is located under theaudio system. To open the coin box,pull the bottom edge. Close it with afirm push.

To open the console compartment,pull up on the left lever and lift thelid.

To close, lower the lid and push itdown until it latches.

You can put small items in the traylocated in the console compartmentlid. To use the tray, pull up on theright lever and lift up the armrestpad.

Console Compartment Coin Box

Console Compartment, Coin Box

Instruments and Controls106

CCOONNSSOOLLEE CCOOMMPPAARRTTMMEENNTT

LLEEVVEERR LLEEVVEERR

CCOOIINN BBOOXX

00/12/25 14:11:18 31S0K630_109

Page 110: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Small, lidded storage compartmentsare located in the armrest of thefront passenger’s door, and in thearmrests of both rear doors. To opena compartment, pivot the lid up.

To remove a storage compartmentfor emptying, open the lid, thencarefully pull the compartmentstraight up and out of the armrest.

These storage compartments canalso be used as ashtrays. Make sureyou remove any flammable materialsfrom the compartment before usingit as an ashtray.

Armrest Storage Compartments

Instruments and Controls 107

00/12/25 14:11:25 31S0K630_110

Page 111: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The rear seat also has a beverageholder in the center armrest. To useit, pivot the armrest down.

To open the beverage holder, pushon the button. The beverage holderlid is spring-loaded and will swingopen. To close it, push either half ofthe lid closed.

Be careful when you are using thebeverage holder. A spilled liquid thatis very hot can scald you or yourpassengers. Spilled liquids can alsodamage the upholstery, carpeting,and electrical components in theinterior.

The beverage holder can beremoved. To remove it, lift up thefront of the holder by holding it atthe middle. To reinstall it, put in theback of the holder, align the fronttabs in the slots and push down thefront of the holder.

Beverage Holder

Instruments and Controls108

00/12/25 14:11:34 31S0K630_111

Page 112: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To use the sun visor, pull it down.You can also use the sun visor at theside window. Remove the supportrod from the clip and swing the sunvisor toward the side window. In thisposition, the sun visor can beextended by sliding out theextension.

To use a vanity mirror on the back ofthe sun visor, pull up the cover.

The light beside the mirror comeson only when the headlight switch isin one of the on positions.

Make sure you put the sun visorback in place when you are gettinginto or out of the car. Do not use thesun visor extension over the rearview mirror.

Sun Visor Vanity Mirror

Sun Visor, Vanity Mirror

Instruments and Controls 109

00/12/25 14:11:44 31S0K630_112

Page 113: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Some larger styles of sunglassesmay not fit in the holder.

To open the sunglasses holder, pushon the front edge. It will unlatch andswing down. To close it, push it untilit latches. Make sure the holder isclosed while you are driving.

Your car has two accessory powersockets. One is located on the frontpanel next to the coin box, and theother is in the console compartment.To use an accessory power socket,the ignition switch must be inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II).

To open the socket on the frontpanel, pull the cover down.

You may also store small items inthis holder. Make sure they aresmall enough to let the holder closeand latch, and that they are notheavy enough to cause the holder topop open while driving.

Sunglasses Holder Accessory Power Sockets

Sunglasses Holder, Accessory Power Sockets

Instruments and Controls110

Push

00/12/25 14:11:56 31S0K630_113

Page 114: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The ceiling light has a three-positionswitch. In the OFF position, the lightdoes not come on. In the centerposition, the ceiling light comes onwhen you open any door. The lightfades out after all doors are closed.In the ON position, the ceiling lightstays on continuously.

These sockets are intended to supplypower for 12 volt DC accessoriesthat are rated 120 watts or less (10amps).

To use the socket in the consolecompartment, pull the cover up.

The ceiling light (with the switch inthe center position) also comes onwhen you unlock the door with theremote transmitter (see page ).

They will not power an automotivetype cigarette lighter element.

81

Ceiling Light

Accessory Power Sockets, Interior Lights

Instruments and Controls 111

OOFFFF

OONN

DDOOOORR AACCTTIIVVAATTEEDDAACCCCEESSSSOORRYY PPOOWWEERR SSOOCCKKEETT

CCOOVVEERR

00/12/25 14:12:06 31S0K630_114

Page 115: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The courtesy light in each front doorcomes on when the door is opened,and goes out when the door is closed.

Your car also has a courtesy light inthe ignition switch. This light comeson when you open the driver’s door.It remains on for several secondsafter the door is closed.

Turn on the spotlight by pushing thebutton next to each light. Push thebutton again to turn it off. You canuse the spotlights at all times.

The storage tray is located above theaudio system. Push on the center ofthe tray to get it to pop out. Thenremove it by pulling it straight out.

Cars without Navigation System

Courtesy LightsSpotlights Storage Tray

Instruments and Controls

Interior Lights, Storage Tray

112

IIGGNNIITTIIOONN SSWWIITTCCHH LLIIGGHHTT

DDOOOORR LLIIGGHHTT SSTTOORRAAGGEE TTRRAAYY

00/12/25 14:12:18 31S0K630_115

Page 116: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

You can put a writing pad, pen, andsmall items in the inner box in thestorage tray. Lift the lid to use thetray.

To reinstall the storage tray into thedashboard, close the lid, then pushthe storage tray in until it latches.

Instruments and Controls

Storage Tray

113

00/12/25 14:12:23 31S0K630_116

Page 117: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

114

Page 118: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

...............Climate Control System . 116

.......Fully-automatic Operation . 118

.......Semi-automatic Operation . 119

.......Fully-automatic Operation . 123

.......Semi-automatic Operation . 124Sunlight Sensor/

............Temperature Sensor . 128................................Audio System . 129

.................Operating the Radio . 130

.................Adjusting the Sound . 134............Audio System Lighting . 135

....................Radio Frequencies . 135........................Radio Reception . 135

Operating the Cassette.....................................Player . 137

............Tape Search Functions . 138Caring for the Cassette

.....................................Player . 141.....Operating the CD Changer . 142

.......Protecting Compact Discs . 148CD Changer Error

.............................Indications . 149...........Remote Audio Controls . 150

.......................Theft Protection . 151

............................Security System . 152...............................Cruise Control . 153

Homelink Universal................................Transceiver . 157

3.2 TL without Navigation System

3.2 TL with Navigation System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Comfort and Convenience Features 115

00/12/25 14:12:31 31S0K630_118

Page 119: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The automatic climate controlsystem in your Acura picks theproper combination of air condi-tioning, heating, and ventilation tomaintain the interior temperatureyou select. The system also adjuststhe fan speed and air flow levels.

The direction of air flow from thevents in the center and each side ofthe dashboard, and in back of thecenter console is adjustable.

For the climate control system toprovide heating and cooling, theengine must be running.

The climate control system draws airthrough the exterior vents at thebottom of the windshield. Keepthese vents clear of leaves and otherdebris.

To adjust the air flow from each vent,move the tab in the center of eachvent up-and-down and side-to-side.

The side and rear vents can beopened and closed with the dials.

Climate Control System

Comfort and Convenience Features116

CCEENNTTEERR VVEENNTTSS DDRRIIVVEERR’’SS--SSIIDDEE VVEENNTT

00/12/25 14:12:40 31S0K630_119

Page 120: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Climate Control System

Comfort and Convenience Features 117

PPAASSSSEENNGGEERR’’SS--SSIIDDEE VVEENNTT

RREEAARR VVEENNTTSS DDIIAALL

TTAABBSS

00/12/25 14:12:46 31S0K630_120

Page 121: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The system automatically selects theproper mix of conditioned and/orheated air that will, as quickly aspossible, raise or lower the interiortemperature from its current level tothe set temperature.

To put the Automatic ClimateControl in fully-automatic mode,press the AUTO button and set thefan control dial to AUTO, then setthe desired temperature by turningthe temperature control dial. You willsee FULL AUTO in the system’sdisplay. The light in the

button also shows you whichmode, Recirculation or Fresh Air, isselected.

When you set the temperature to itslower limit (60°F/18°C) or its upperlimit (90°F/32°C), the system runsat full cooling or heating only. It doesnot regulate the interior temperature.

When the temperature is setbetween the lower and upper limits,the system regulates the interiortemperature to the set value.

Pressing the OFF button shuts theclimate control system completelyoff. Keep the system completely offonly for short periods. To keep staleair and mustiness from collecting,you should have the fan running atall times.

Climate Control System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Fully-automatic Operation3.2 TL without Navigation System

118

TTEEMMPPEERRAATTUURREECCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

FFAANN CCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

OOFFFF BBUUTTTTOONNAAUUTTOO BBUUTTTTOONN

FFUULLLL AAUUTTOODDIISSPPLLAAYY

00/12/25 14:12:54 31S0K630_121

Page 122: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

You can manually select variousfunctions of the Climate Controlsystem when it is in FULL AUTO.All other features remain auto-matically controlled. Making anymanual selection causes the wordFULL to go out.

Press the A/C button to turn the airconditioning on and off. You will seeA/C ON or A/C OFF in the display.

When you turn the A/C off, the sys-tem cannot regulate the inside tem-perature if you set the dial below theoutside temperature. With the A/Con, use the temperature control dialto adjust the temperature of the airflow to a comfortable setting.

Climate Control System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Semi-automatic Operation

Air Conditioning (A/C) Button

119

RREECCIIRRCCUULLAATTIIOONN BBUUTTTTOONN

AAIIRR CCOONNDDIITTIIOONNIINNGG BBUUTTTTOONN

TTEEMMPPEERRAATTUURREE CCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

00/12/25 14:13:04 31S0K630_122

Page 123: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

You can manually select the fanspeed by turning the fan control dial.When you turn the dial clockwise,the fan is taken out of automaticmode and starts to run at its lowestspeed. Turning the dial fullyclockwise increases the fan’s speed,which increases air flow.

This button controls the source ofthe air going into the system. Whenthe indicator in this button is lit, airfrom the car’s interior is sentthrough the system again(Recirculation mode). When theindicator is off, air is brought in fromoutside the car (Fresh Air mode).You can, for example, manually putthe system in recirculation modewhen driving through an area ofsmoke or fumes.

Use the MODE button to select thevents the air flows from. Some airwill flow from the side vents and thedashboard corner vents in all modes.Each time you press the MODEbutton, the display shows the modeselected. Press the button four timesto see all the modes.

Mode Button

Fan Control Dial

Recirculation Button

Climate Control System

Comfort and Convenience Features120

MMOODDEE BBUUTTTTOONN FFAANN CCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

RREECCIIRRCCUULLAATTIIOONN BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:13:13 31S0K630_123

Page 124: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The main air flow is dividedbetween the dashboard vents andthe floor vents.

The main air flow is dividedbetween the floor vents and de-froster vents at the base of the wind-shield.

The main air flow comesfrom the floor vents.

The main air flow comesfrom the dashboard vents.

CONTINUED

Climate Control System

Comfort and Convenience Features 121

00/12/25 14:13:22 31S0K630_124

Page 125: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The button directs the mainair flow to the windshield for fasterdefrosting. It also overrides anyMODE selection you may have made.

When you select , the A/Cturns on automatically and thesystem selects Fresh Air mode. Ifthe fan control dial is in AUTO, thefan speed increases automatically. Ifit is not in AUTO, manually increasethe fan speed or set the dial toAUTO. You can increase air flow tothe windshield by closing the sidevents in the dashboard.

When you turn off bypressing the button again, thesystem returns to its former settings.

This button turns the rear windowdefogger on and off (see page ).74

Climate Control System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Rear Window Defogger Button

122

RREEAARR WWIINNDDOOWW DDEEFFOOGGGGEERR BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:13:32 31S0K630_125

Page 126: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

▲▼

Pressing the OFF button shuts theclimate control system completelyoff. Keep the system completely offonly for short periods. To keep staleair and mustiness from collecting,you should have the fan running atall times.

To put the Automatic ClimateControl in fully-automatic mode,press the AUTO button. Theindicator in the button will light.Then set the desired temperature bypressing either side of the TEMPbutton: to raise the temperatureabove the displayed value, or tolower the temperature. The light inthe button also shows youwhich mode, Recirculation or FreshAir, is selected.

The system automatically selects theproper mix of conditioned and/orheated air that will, as quickly aspossible, raise or lower the interiortemperature from its current level tothe set temperature.

When you set the temperature to itslower limit (60°F/18°C) or its upperlimit (90°F/32°C), the system runsat full cooling or heating only. It does

not regulate the interior temperature.When the temperature is setbetween the lower and upper limits,the system regulates the interiortemperature to the set value.

Fully-automatic Operation

Comfort and Convenience Features

Climate Control System

3.2 TL with Navigation System

123

OOFFFF BBUUTTTTOONN

TTEEMMPPEERRAATTUURREE DDIISSPPLLAAYY

AAUUTTOO BBUUTTTTOONN

RREECCIIRRCCUULLAATTIIOONN BBUUTTTTOONN

TTEEMMPPEERRAATTUURREE BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:13:41 31S0K630_126

Page 127: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

You can manually select variousfunctions of the Climate Controlsystem when it is in FULL AUTO.All other features remainautomatically controlled. Some ofthese functions appear in theNavigation System display. Press theA/C button next to the display toshow these functions. Making anymanual selection causes theindicator in the AUTO button to goout.

Pressing ‘‘ON’’ or ‘‘OFF’’ in thedisplay turns the air conditioning onand off. You will see A/C ON or A/COFF activated in the display.

Semi-automatic Operation

A/C (Air Conditioning) On/Off Icons

Climate Control System

Comfort and Convenience Features124

AA//CC OONN//OOFFFF IICCOONNSS

AA//CC BBUUTTTTOONN

RREECCIIRRCCUULLAATTIIOONN BBUUTTTTOONN TTEEMMPPEERRAATTUURREE BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:13:50 31S0K630_127

Page 128: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

You can manually select the fanspeed by pressing any of the fancontrol icons.

This button controls the source ofthe air going into the system. Whenthe indicator in this button is lit, airfrom the car’s interior is sentthrough the system again(Recirculation mode). When theindicator is off, air is brought in fromoutside the car (Fresh Air mode).You can, for example, manually putthe system in recirculation modewhen driving through an area ofsmoke or fumes.

When you turn the A/C off, thesystem cannot regulate the insidetemperature if you set it below theoutside temperature. With the A/Con, use the temperature buttons toadjust the temperature of the airflow to a comfortable setting.

CONTINUED

Climate Control System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Fan Control Icons

Recirculation Button

125

FFAANN CCOONNTTRROOLL IICCOONNSS

MMOODDEE IICCOONNSS

RREECCIIRRCCUULLAATTIIOONN BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:13:59 31S0K630_128

Page 129: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The main air flow comesfrom the dashboard vents.

The main air flow is dividedbetween the dashboard vents andthe floor vents.

The main air flow comesfrom the floor vents.

The main air flow is dividedbetween the floor vents and de-froster vents at the base of the wind-shield.

Use the MODE icons to select thevents the air flows from. Some airwill flow from the dashboard cornervents and the side vents in all modes.

Mode Icons

Comfort and Convenience Features

Climate Control System

126

00/12/25 14:14:10 31S0K630_129

Page 130: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The button directs the mainair flow to the windshield for fasterdefrosting. It also overrides anyMODE selection you may have made.

When you select , the A/Cturns on automatically, the systemselects Fresh Air mode, and the fanspeed increases. You can increase airflow to the windshield by closing theside vents in the dashboard.

When you turn off bypressing the button again, thesystem returns to its former settings.

This button turns the rear windowdefogger on and off (see page ).74

Rear Window Defogger Button

Climate Control System

Comfort and Convenience Features 127

RREEAARR WWIINNDDOOWW DDEEFFOOGGGGEERR BBUUTTTTOONN

DDEEFFRROOSSTT BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:14:18 31S0K630_130

Page 131: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The climate control system has twosensors. A sunlight sensor is locatedin the top of the dashboard and atemperature sensor is next to thesteering column. Do not cover thesensors or spill any liquid on them.

Sunlight Sensor/TemperatureSensor

Climate Control System

Comfort and Convenience Features128

TTEEMMPPEERRAATTUURREE SSEENNSSOORRSSUUNNLLIIGGHHTT SSEENNSSOORR

00/12/25 14:14:25 31S0K630_131

Page 132: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Your Acura’s audio system providesclear reception on both AM and FMbands, while the preset buttons allowyou to easily select your favoritestations.

The anti-theft feature will disable thesystem if it is disconnected from thecar’s battery. To get the systemworking again, you must enter acode number (see page ).

The cassette system features Dolbynoise reduction, automatic sensing ofchromium-dioxide (CrO ) tape, andautoreverse for continuous play.

The in-dash CD changer holds up tosix discs. You operate the CDchanger with the same controls usedfor the radio. See page for CDchanger operation.

142

151

2

Dolby noise reduction manufactured underlicense from Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corpo-ration. ‘‘DOLBY’’ and the double-D symbol

are trademarks of Dolby LaboratoriesLicensing Corporation.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

AM/FM/Cassette/CD ChangerAudio System

129

00/12/25 14:14:35 31S0K630_132

Page 133: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The ignition switch must be inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) tooperate the audio system. Turn thesystem on by pressing the PWR/VOL knob or the AM or FM button.Adjust the volume by turning theknob.

The band and frequency that theradio was last tuned to is displayed.To change bands, press the AM orFM button. On the FM band, ST willbe displayed if the station is broad-casting in stereo. Stereoreproduction on AM is not available.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Operating the Radio

130

SSCCAANN BBUUTTTTOONN PPRREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONNSS SSEEEEKK BBUUTTTTOONNSS

PPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB AAMMBBUUTTTTOONN

FFMMBBUUTTTTOONN

SSTTEERREEOOIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

TTUUNNEE KKNNOOBB

00/12/25 14:14:42 31S0K630_133

Page 134: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

○ ○- +

To store a frequency:

Select the desired band, AM orFM. FM1 and FM2 let you storetwo frequencies with each Presetbutton.

Pick the Preset button you wantfor that station. Press the buttonand hold it until you hear a beep.Repeat steps 1 to 3 to store a totalof six stations on AM and twelveon FM.

Once a station’s frequency is stored,simply press and release the properpreset button to tune to it.

The SCAN functionsamples all the stations with strongsignals on the selected band. Toactivate it, press the SCAN button,then release it. When the system isin the SCAN mode, SCAN shows inthe display. The system will scan upthe band for a station with a strongsignal. When it finds one, it will stopand play that station forapproximately five seconds. If you donothing, the system will then scanfor the next strong station and playthat for five seconds. When it plays astation that you want to continuelistening to, press the SCAN buttonagain.

You can store thefrequencies of your favorite radiostations in the six preset buttons.Each button will store one frequencyon the AM band, and twofrequencies on the FM band.

The preset frequencies will be lost ifyour car’s battery goes dead, isdisconnected, or the radio fuse isremoved.

You can use any of four methods tofind radio stations on the selectedband: TUNE, SEEK, SCAN or thePreset buttons.

Use the TUNE knob totune the radio to a desired frequency.Turn the TUNE knob to the right totune to a higher frequency, or to theleft to tune to a lower frequency.Turn the knob right or left until thedisplay reaches the desiredfrequency.

The SEEK functionsearches the band for a station witha strong signal. To activate it, presseither SEEK button ( or ), thenrelease it. Depending on whichSEEK button you press, the systemscans upward or downward from thecurrent frequency. It stops when itfinds a station with a strong signal.

Use the TUNE or SEEK functionto tune the radio to a desiredstation.

1.

2.

3.

4.

CONTINUED

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

SCAN

Preset

TUNE

SEEK

131

00/12/25 14:14:56 31S0K630_134

Page 135: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

- If you aretraveling far from home and can nolonger receive the stations youpreset, you can use the Auto Selectfeature to find stations in the localarea.

If you are in a remote area, AutoSelect may not find six strong AMstations or twelve strong FM stations.If this happens, you will see a ‘‘0’’displayed when you press any presetbutton that does not have a stationstored.

To activate Auto Select, press theA. SEL button. A. SEL will flash inthe display, and the system will gointo scan mode for several seconds.It automatically scans both bands,looking for stations with strongsignals. It stores the frequencies ofsix AM stations and twelve FMstations in the preset buttons. Youcan then use the preset buttons toselect those stations.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

AUTO SELECT

132

AA.. SSEELL BBUUTTTTOONN

AA.. SSEELL IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

00/12/25 14:15:04 31S0K630_135

Page 136: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If you do not like the stations AutoSelect has stored, you can storeother frequencies in the presetbuttons. Use the TUNE, SEEK, orSCAN function to find the desiredfrequencies, then store them in theselected preset buttons as describedpreviously.

Auto Select does not erase thefrequencies that you preset pre-viously. When you return home, turnoff Auto Select by pressing theA. SEL button. The preset buttonswill then select the frequencies youoriginally set.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features 133

PPRREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONNSS

SSCCAANN BBUUTTTTOONN

SSEEEEKK BBUUTTTTOONNSSAA..SSEELL BBUUTTTTOONN

AA..SSEELL IINNDDIICCAATTOORR TTUUNNEE KKNNOOBB

00/12/25 14:15:11 31S0K630_136

Page 137: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Bass, Treble, Balance, and Fader areeach adjustable. You select which ofthese you want to adjust by pressingthe TUNE knob. The mode changesfrom BAS to TRE to FAD to BAL,and then back to the selected audiomode, each time you press theTUNE knob.

Use these modes toadjust the tone to your liking. SelectTRE or BAS by pressing the TUNEknob. Adjust the desired mode byturning the TUNE knob. The levelindicators on the display show youthe range.

These twomodes adjust the strength of thesound coming from each speaker.BAL adjusts the side-to-side strength,while FAD adjusts the front-to-backstrength.

Select BAL or FAD by pressing theTUNE knob. Adjust the Balance orFader to your liking by turning theTUNE knob. The level indicators onthe display show you the range.

The system will automatically returnthe display to the selected audiomode about five seconds after youstop adjusting a mode with theTUNE knob.

Adjusting the Sound

Treble/Bass

Balance/Fader

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features134

TTUUNNEE KKNNOOBBLLEEVVEELL IINNDDIICCAATTOORRSS

00/12/25 14:15:21 31S0K630_137

Page 138: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

Your Acura’s radio can receive thecomplete AM and FM bands.Those bands cover these frequen-cies:

AM band:530 to 1,710 kilohertzFM band:87.7 to 107.9 megahertz

Radio stations on the AM band areassigned frequencies at least tenkilohertz apart (530, 540, 550).Stations on the FM band areassigned frequencies at least 0.2megahertz apart (87.9, 88.1, 88.3).

Stations must use these exactfrequencies. It is fairly common forstations to round-off the frequency intheir advertising, so your radio coulddisplay a frequency of 100.9 eventhough the announcer may identifythe station as ‘‘FM101.’’

How well your Acura’s radio receivesstations is dependent on manyfactors, such as the distance fromthe station’s transmitter, nearbylarge objects, and atmosphericconditions.

A radio station’s signal gets weakeras you get farther away from itstransmitter. If you are listening to anAM station, you will notice the soundvolume becoming weaker, and thestation drifting in and out. If you arelistening to an FM station, you willsee the stereo indicator flickering offand on as the signal weakens.Eventually, the stereo indicator will

go off and the sound will fadecompletely as you get out of range ofthe station’s signal.

Driving very near the transmitter ofa station that is broadcasting on afrequency close to the frequency ofthe station you are listening to canalso affect your radio’s reception.You may temporarily hear bothstations, or hear only the station youare close to.

You can use the instrument panelbrightness control dial to adjust the il-lumination of the audio system (seepage ). The audio systemilluminates when the parking lightsare on, even if the radio is turned off.

71

Audio System Lighting

Radio Frequencies Radio Reception

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features 135

00/12/25 14:15:35 31S0K630_138

Page 139: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Radio signals, especially on the FMband, are deflected by large objectssuch as buildings and hills. Yourradio then receives both the directsignal from the station’s transmitter,and the deflected signal. This causesthe sound to distort or flutter. This isa main cause of poor radio receptionin city driving.

Radio reception can be affected byatmospheric conditions such asthunderstorms, high humidity, andeven sunspots. You may be able toreceive a distant radio station oneday and not receive it the next daybecause of a change in conditions.

Electrical interference from passingvehicles and stationary sources cancause temporary reception problems.

As required by the FCC:Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features136

00/12/25 14:15:44 31S0K630_139

Page 140: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The ignition switch must be inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II).Make sure the tape opening on thecassette is facing to the right, theninsert the cassette most of the wayinto the slot. The system will pull itin the rest of the way, and begin toplay.

The tape direction indicator will lightto show you which side of thecassette is playing. The indicatesthe side you inserted facing upwardis now playing. If you want to playthe other side, press the PROGbutton.

If you turn the system off while atape is playing, either with the PWR/VOL knob or by turning off theignition, the cassette will remain inthe drive. When you turn the systemback on, the tape will begin playingwhere it left off.

To switch to the radio or CDchanger while listening to a tape,press the AM, FM or CD button. Tochange back to the cassette player,press the TAPE button.

Dolby noise reduction turns on whenyou insert a cassette. The indi-cator will light in the display. If thetape was not recorded with Dolbynoise reduction, turn it off bypressing the button.

When the system reaches the end ofthe tape, it will automatically reversedirection and play the other side. Ifyou want to remove the cassettefrom the drive, press the EJECTbutton.

Noise reduction remains off until youturn it on by pressing the buttonagain.

You can remove the cassette withthe ignition switch in any position,even if the audio system is turned off.

Operating the Cassette Player

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features 137

00/12/25 14:15:56 31S0K630_140

Page 141: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

With a cassette playing, you can usethe FF, REW, SKIP, or REPEATfunction to find a desired program.

Fast Forward andRewind move the tape rapidly. Torewind the tape, push the REWbutton. You will see REW in thedisplay. To fast forward the tape,push the FF button. You will see FFdisplayed. Press the FF, REW orPLAY button to take the system outof rewind or fast forward. When thesystem reaches the end of the tape,it reverses direction and begins toplay.

Tape Search Functions

FF/REW

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features138

DDOOLLBBYY IINNDDIICCAATTOORRPPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB

AAMM BBUUTTTTOONN

TTAAPPEE DDIIRREECCTTIIOONNIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

CCAASSSSEETTTTEE SSLLOOTT

TTAAPPEE EEJJEECCTTBBUUTTTTOONN

PPLLAAYYBBUUTTTTOONN

PPRROOGGBBUUTTTTOONN

DDOOLLBBYY BBUUTTTTOONN

CCDD BBUUTTTTOONN

FFFF BBUUTTTTOONN

TTAAPPEEBBUUTTTTOONN

RREEWW BBUUTTTTOONNFFMM BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:16:04 31S0K630_141

Page 142: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

○ ○

- +

The SKIP function allowsyou to find the beginning of a songor passage. To skip to the beginningof a song or passage currentlyplaying, push the button. You willsee REW flashing in the display asthe tape rewinds. To skip to thebeginning of the next song, push the

button. You will see FF flashing inthe display as the tape fast forwards.When the system finds the begin-ning of a song or passage, it goesback to PLAY.

To stop the SKIP function before itfinds the beginning of a song orpassage, press either of the SKIPbuttons ( or ).

CONTINUED

SKIP

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features 139

SSKKIIPP BBUUTTTTOONNSSRRPPTT BBUUTTTTOONN

RREEPPEEAATT IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

FFFF BBUUTTTTOONN

RREEWW BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:16:11 31S0K630_142

Page 143: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

- The Repeat functioncontinuously replays the currentsong or passage. Press the RPTbutton to activate it; you will see RPTdisplayed as a reminder. When thesystem reaches the end of the songor passage currently playing, it willautomatically go into rewind. Whenit senses the beginning of the samesong or passage, the system returnsto PLAY mode. It will continue torepeat this same program until youdeactivate REPEAT by pressing thebutton again.Pressing the REW or FF button, oreither of the SKIP buttons, also turnsoff REPEAT.

The SKIP and REPEAT functionsuse silent periods on the tape to findthe end of a song or passage. Thesefeatures may not work to yoursatisfaction if there is almost no gapbetween selections, a high noiselevel between selections, or a silentperiod in the middle of a selection.

REPEAT

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features140

RREEPPEEAATT IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

RREEWW BBUUTTTTOONN

SSKKIIPP BBUUTTTTOONNSSFFFF BBUUTTTTOONNRRPPTT BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:16:18 31S0K630_143

Page 144: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The cassette player picks up dirt andoxides from the tape. This contami-nation builds up over time andcauses the sound quality to degrade.To prevent this, you should clean theplayer after every 30 hours of use.Your dealer has a cleaning kitavailable.

If you do not clean the cassetteplayer regularly, it may eventuallybecome impossible to remove thecontamination with a normalcleaning kit.

Use 100-minute or shorter cassettes.Cassettes longer than that usethinner tape that may break or jamthe drive.

Look at the cassette before youinsert it. If the tape is loose, tightenit by turning a hub with a pencil oryour finger.

When they are not in use, storecassettes in their cases to protectthem from dust and moisture. Neverplace cassettes where they will beexposed to direct sunlight, high heat,or high humidity. If a cassette isexposed to extreme heat or cold, letit reach a moderate temperaturebefore inserting it in the player.

Never try to insert foreign objectsinto the cassette player.

If the label is peeling off, remove itfrom the cassette or it could causethe cassette to jam in the player.Never try to insert a warped ordamaged cassette in the player.

If you see the error indication‘‘ ’’ on the display, press theEJECT button to remove thecassette from the unit. Make surethe tape is not damaged. If thecassette will not eject or the errorindication stays on after the cassetteejects, take the car to your Acuradealer.

Caring for the Cassette Player

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features 141

00/12/25 14:16:30 31S0K630_144

Page 145: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Your Acura’s audio system has an in-dash CD changer that holds up to sixdiscs, providing several hours ofcontinuous entertainment. Youoperate this CD changer with thesame controls used for the radio andcassette player.

To load the CDs or operate the CDchanger, the ignition switch must bein ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II).

Load and play only standard rounddiscs. Odd-shaped CDs may jam inthe drive or cause other problems.You cannot load and play 3-inch(8-cm) discs in this system.

Operating the CD Changer

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features142

SSKKIIPP BBUUTTTTOONNSSCCDD BBUUTTTTOONNRRDDMM BBUUTTTTOONN

RREEPPEEAATT BBUUTTTTOONN

LLOOAADD BBUUTTTTOONN CCDD EEJJEECCTT BBUUTTTTOONN

PPWWRR//VVOOLLKKNNOOBB

CCDD SSLLOOTT

00/12/25 14:16:38 31S0K630_145

Page 146: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To load multiple CDs in oneoperation:

Press and hold the Load buttonuntil you hear a beep and see‘‘_ _ _ _’’ in the display, thenrelease the button.

On the left side of the display, theCD Loaded indicator for an emptyposition will begin blinking.

When LOAd appears again in thedisplay, insert the next disc intothe CD slot.

Repeat this until all six positionsare loaded. The system will thenbegin playing the last CD loaded.

If you are not loading CDs into all sixpositions, press the Load buttonagain after the last CD has loaded.The system will begin playing thelast CD loaded.

If you stop loading CDs before all sixpositions are filled, and you do notpress the Load button, the systemwill wait for ten seconds, then stopthe load operation and begin playingthe last CD loaded.

To load a single CD:

Press and release the Load button.

When the CD Loaded indicator foran empty position starts to blink,and you see LOAd in the display,insert the disc into the CD slot.Insert it only about halfway, thedrive will pull it in the rest of theway.

The system will load the CD, andbegin playing it.When you see LOAd in the display,

insert the disc into the CD slot.Insert it only about halfway, thedrive will pull it in the rest of theway. You will again see the dashesin the display as the CD is loaded.

1.

2.

3.

4.

5.

1.

2.

3.

CONTINUED

Loading CDs in the Changer

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features 143

00/12/25 14:16:54 31S0K630_146

Page 147: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If you press the Load button while aCD is playing, the system will stopplaying that CD and start the loadingsequence. It will then play the CDjust loaded.

You can also load a CD into an emptyposition while a CD is playing bypressing the appropriate presetbutton. Select an empty position (theCD Loaded indicator is off), andpress the preset button for thatposition (1 to 6). The system willstop playing the current CD and startthe loading sequence. It will thenplay the CD just loaded.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features144

LLOOAADD BBUUTTTTOONN

AAMM BBUUTTTTOONN PPRREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONNSS

CCDD SSLLOOTTFFMMBBUUTTTTOONN

CCDD LLOOAADDEEDDIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

TTAAPPEE BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:17:01 31S0K630_147

Page 148: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

○○

+-

Select the CD changer by pressingthe CD button. You will see ‘‘Cd’’ inthe display. The system will beginplaying the last selected disc in theCD changer. You will see the discand track numbers displayed.

When that disc ends, the next disc inthe CD changer is loaded and played.After the last disc finishes, thesystem returns to disc 1.

To select a different disc, press theappropriate Preset button (1 6). Ifyou select an empty position in theCD changer, the system will go intothe loading sequence (see page ).

You can use the SKIP buttons whilea disc is playing to select passagesand change tracks.

To activate the Repeatfeature, press and release the RPTbutton. You will see RPT in thedisplay as a reminder. The systemcontinuously replays the currenttrack. Press the RPT button again toturn it off. Pressing either of theSKIP buttons also turns off therepeat feature.

This feature,when activated, plays the trackswithin a CD in random order, ratherthan in the order they are recordedon the CD. To activate Random Play,press the RDM button. You will seeRDM in the display. The system willthen select and play tracks randomly.This continues until you deactivateRandom Play by pressing the RDMbutton again, or you select adifferent CD with a preset button.

To move rapidly within a track, pressand hold the appropriate SKIPbutton. You will hear a beep and thesystem will continue to move. Pressthe button to move forward, orthe button to move backward.Release the button when the systemreaches the point you want.

Each time you press the buttonand release it, the system skipsforward to the beginning of the nexttrack. Press and release thebutton to skip backward to thebeginning of the current track. Pressand release it again to skip to thebeginning of the previous track.

143

CONTINUED

Operation REPEAT

RANDOM PLAY

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features 145

00/12/25 14:17:12 31S0K630_148

Page 149: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To take the system out of CD mode,press the AM or FM button, or inserta cassette in the player. If a tape isalready in the cassette player, pressthe TAPE button. When you returnto CD mode by pressing the CDbutton, play will continue at the samepoint that it left off.

If you turn the system off while a CDis playing, either with the PWR/VOLknob or the ignition switch, play willcontinue at the same point when youturn it back on.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features146

PPRREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONNSS SSKKIIPP BBUUTTTTOONNSSRRPPTT BBUUTTTTOONN RRDDMMBBUUTTTTOONN

RRDDMMIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

RRPPTTIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

PPWWRR//VVOOLLKKNNOOBB

AAMM BBUUTTTTOONN FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN

CCDDBBUUTTTTOONN

TTAAPPEEBBUUTTTTOONN

CCDD EEJJEECCTTBBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:17:19 31S0K630_149

Page 150: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To remove the disc that is currentlyplaying, press the Eject button. Youwill see ‘‘EJEC’’ in the display. Whenyou remove the disc from the slot,the system automatically begins theLoad sequence so you can loadanother CD in that position. If you donot load another CD, after tenseconds the system begins playingthe next disc in the changer. If thechanger is empty, the system selectsthe previous mode (AM, FM, orTape).

If you do not remove the disc fromthe slot, the system will reload thedisc after ten seconds and beginplaying it.

To remove a different CD from thechanger, first select it with theappropriate preset button. When thatCD begins playing, press the Ejectbutton.

If you press the Eject button whilelistening to the radio or tape, or withthe audio system turned off, the discthat was last selected is ejected.After that disc is ejected, pressingthe Eject button again will eject thenext disc in the numerical order. Bydoing this six times, you can removeall the CDs from the changer.

In any mode, if you press the Ejectbutton and hold it until you hear abeep, the system will eject all of thediscs in the changer.

You can also eject discs when theignition switch is off. The disc thatwas last selected is ejected first. Youcan eject all six discs, one at atime.

Removing CDs from the Changer

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features 147

00/12/25 14:17:29 31S0K630_150

Page 151: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Handle a CD by its edges; nevertouch either surface. Contaminationfrom fingerprints, liquids, felt-tippens, and labels can cause the CD tonot play properly, or possibly jam inthe drive.

When a CD is not being played, storeit in its case to protect it from dustand other contamination. To preventwarpage, keep CDs out of directsunlight and extreme heat.

To clean a disc, use a clean soft cloth.Wipe across the disc from the centerto the outside edge.

Never try to insert foreign objects inthe CD player or the magazine.

A new CD may be rough on theinner and outer edges. The smallplastic pieces causing this roughnesscan flake off and fall on the re-cording surface of the disc, causingskipping or other problems. Removethese pieces by rubbing the innerand outer edges with the side of apencil or pen.

Protecting Compact Discs

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features148

00/12/25 14:17:39 31S0K630_151

Page 152: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If you see an error indication in thedisplay while operating the CDchanger, find the cause in the chartto the right. If you cannot clear theerror indication, take the car to yourAcura dealer.

Indication Cause Solution

Disc-changermalfunction.High temperature.

Disc-changermalfunction.High temperature.

Misconnection ordisconnection ofoptional trunk-mountedCD changer.No CD magazine in theoptional trunk-mountedCD changer.No CD in magazine.

Consult your Acura dealer.

Will disappear when the temperature returns tonormal.Consult your Acura dealer.

Will disappear when the temperature returns tonormal.

See your Acura dealer.

Insert a CD magazine.

Insert a CD in magazine.

CD Changer Error Indications

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features 149

00/12/25 14:17:51 31S0K630_152

Page 153: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

▲ ▼The top and bottom buttons adjustthe volume up ( ) or down ( ).Press the proper button and hold ituntil the desired volume is reached,then release it.

The AUDIO/CH button has threefunctions, depending on whether youare listening to the radio, or playing acassette or CD.

If you are listening to the radio, usethe AUDIO/CH button to changestations. Each time you press thisbutton, the system advances to thenext preset station on the band youare listening to. You will see thenumber of the selected Preset buttonin the display. To change bands,press the AM or FM button on theaudio system’s front panel.

If you are playing a cassette, use theAUDIO/CH button to advance to thenext selection. You will see ‘‘FF’’blinking in the display when youpress the AUDIO/CH button. Thesystem fast forwards until it senses asilent period, then goes back toPLAY.

If you are playing a CD, the systemskips to the beginning of the nexttrack each time you push theAUDIO/CH button. You will see thedisc and track number in the display.

Two controls for the audio systemare mounted in the steering wheelhub. These let you control basicfunctions without removing yourhand from the wheel.

Remote Audio Controls

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features150

AAUUDDIIOO//CCHHBBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:18:02 31S0K630_153

Page 154: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

You will have to store your favoritestations in the Preset buttons afterthe system begins working. Youroriginal settings were lost whenpower was disconnected.

Your car’s audio system will disableitself if it is disconnected fromelectrical power for any reason. Tomake it work again, the user mustenter a specific five-digit code in thePreset buttons. Because there arehundreds of number combinationspossible from five digits, making thesystem work without knowing theexact code is nearly impossible.

You should have received a card thatlists your audio system’s codenumber and serial number. It is bestto store this card in a safe place athome. In addition, you should writethe audio system’s serial number inthis Owner’s Manual. If you shouldhappen to lose the card, you mustobtain the code number from yourAcura dealer. To do this, you willneed the system’s serial number.

If your car’s battery is disconnectedor goes dead, or the radio fuse isremoved, the audio system willdisable itself. If this happens, youwill see ‘‘Code’’ in the frequencydisplay the next time you turn on thesystem. Use the Preset buttons toenter the five-digit code. If it isentered correctly, the radio will startplaying.

If you make a mistake entering thecode, do not start over or try tocorrect your mistake. Complete thefive-digit sequence, then enter thecorrect code. You have ten tries toenter the correct code. If you areunsuccessful in ten attempts, youmust then leave the system on forone hour before trying again.

Theft Protection

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features 151

00/12/25 14:18:10 31S0K630_154

Page 155: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Once the security system is set,opening any door (without using thekey or the remote transmitter), orthe hood, will cause it to alarm. Italso alarms if the radio is removedfrom the dashboard or the wiring iscut.

The security system sets auto-matically fifteen seconds after youlock the doors, hood, and trunk. Forthe system to activate, you must lockthe doors from the outside with thekey, lock tab, door lock switch, orremote transmitter. The securitysystem light next to the driver’s doorlock starts blinking immediately toshow you the system is setting itself.

The security system helps to protectyour car and valuables from theft.The horn sounds and a combinationof headlights, parking lights, sidemarker lights and taillights flashes ifsomeone attempts to break into yourcar or remove the radio. This alarmcontinues for two minutes, then thesystem resets. To reset an alarmingsystem before the two minutes haveelapsed, unlock either front doorwith the key or the remotetransmitter.

With the system set, you can stillopen the trunk with the remotetransmitter without triggering thealarm. The alarm will sound if thetrunk is opened with the trunkrelease button on the driver’s door,the trunk release handle behind thetrunk pass-through cover, or theemergency trunk opener.

The security system will not set ifthe hood, trunk, or any door is notfully closed. If the system will not set,check the Door and Trunk OpenMonitor on the instrument panel(see page ), to see if the doorsand trunk are fully closed. Since it isnot part of the monitor display,manually check the hood.

Do not attempt to alter this systemor add other devices to it.

62

Security System

Comfort and Convenience Features152

SSEECCUURRIITTYY SSYYSSTTEEMM LLIIGGHHTT

00/12/25 14:18:20 31S0K630_155

Page 156: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Accelerate to the desired cruisingspeed above 25 mph (40 km/h).

Push in the Cruise Control MasterSwitch to the left of the steeringcolumn. The indicator in theswitch will light.

Cruise control allows you to maintaina set speed above 25 mph (40 km/h)without keeping your foot on theaccelerator pedal. It should be usedfor cruising on straight, openhighways. It is not recommended forconditions such as city driving,winding roads, slippery roads, heavyrain, or bad weather. You shouldhave full control of the car underthose conditions.

1.

2.

CONTINUED

Using the Cruise Control

Cruise Control

Comfort and Convenience Features 153

CCRRUUIISSEE CCOONNTTRROOLL MMAASSTTEERR SSWWIITTCCHH

Improper use of the cruisecontrol can lead to a crash.

Use the cruise control onlywhen traveling on openhighways in good weather.

00/12/25 14:18:29 31S0K630_156

Page 157: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Press and release the SET/decelbutton on the steering wheel. TheCRUISE CONTROL light on theinstrument panel comes on toshow the system is now activated.

You can increase the set cruisingspeed in any of these ways:

Press and hold the RESUME/accel button. The car will acceler-ate. When you reach the desiredcruising speed, release the button.

To increase your speed in verysmall amounts, tap the RESUME/accel button repeatedly. Each timeyou do this, your car will speed upabout 1 mph (1.6 km/h).

Push on the accelerator pedal. Ac-celerate to the desired cruisingspeed and press the SET/decelbutton.

The cruise control may not hold theset speed when you are going up anddown hills. If your speed increasesgoing down a hill, use the brakes toslow down to the desired speed. Thiswill cancel the cruise control. Toresume the set speed, press theRESUME/accel button. TheCRUISE CONTROL light on theinstrument panel comes on.

When climbing a steep hill, theautomatic transmission maydownshift to hold the set speed.

3.

Changing the Set Speed

Cruise Control

Comfort and Convenience Features154

RREESSUUMMEE//aacccceell

SSEETT//ddeecceell

CCAANNCCEELL

00/12/25 14:18:40 31S0K630_157

Page 158: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

You can decrease the set cruisingspeed in any of these ways:

Press and hold the SET/decelbutton. The car will decelerate.Release the button when youreach the desired speed.

To slow down in very smallamounts, tap the SET/decelbutton repeatedly. Each time youdo this, your car will slow downabout 1 mph (1.6 km/h).

Even with the cruise control turnedon, you can still use the acceleratorpedal to speed up for passing. Aftercompleting the pass, take your footoff the accelerator pedal. The carwill return to the set cruising speed.

Resting your foot on the brake pedalwill cause the cruise control tocancel.

You can cancel the cruise control inany of these ways:

Tap the brake pedal.

Push the CANCEL button on thesteering wheel.

Press the Cruise Control MasterSwitch.

Tap the brake pedal lightly withyour foot. The CRUISECONTROL light on theinstrument panel will go out.When the car slows to the desiredspeed, press the SET/decel button.The car will then maintain thedesired speed.

CONTINUED

Cancelling the Cruise Control

Cruise Control

Comfort and Convenience Features 155

CCAANNCCEELL BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:18:54 31S0K630_158

Page 159: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Pressing the Cruise Control MasterSwitch turns the system completelyoff and erases the previous cruisingspeed from memory. To use thesystem again, refer to

.

When you push the CANCEL button,or tap the brake pedal, the CRUISECONTROL light on the instrumentpanel will go out and the car willbegin to slow down. You can use theaccelerator pedal in the normal way.

The system remembers thepreviously-set cruising speed. Toreturn to that speed, accelerate toabove 25 mph (40 km/h), then pressand release the RESUME/accelbutton. The CRUISE CONTROLlight comes on, and the car willaccelerate to the same cruisingspeed as before.

Using theCruise Control

Cruise Control

Comfort and Convenience Features156

00/12/25 14:18:59 31S0K630_159

Page 160: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The HomeLink UniversalTransceiver built into your car canbe programmed to operate remotely-controlled devices around your home,such as garage doors, lighting, orhome security systems. It canreplace up to three remotetransmitters.

If you have problems with trainingthe HomeLink Universal Transceiver,or would like information on homeproducts that can be operated by thetransmitter, call (800) 355-3515. Onthe Internet, go to www.homelink.com.

Always refer to the operatinginstructions and safety informationthat came with your garage dooropener or other equipment youintend to operate with the HomeLinkUniversal Transceiver. If you do nothave this information, you shouldcontact the manufacturer of theequipment.

While training or using HomeLink,make sure you have a clear view ofthe garage door or gate, and that noone will be injured by its movement.

If you are training HomeLink tooperate a garage door or gate, it isrecommended that you unplug themotor for that device during training.Repeatedly pressing the remotecontrol button could burn out themotor.

HomeLink stores the code in apermanent memory. There shouldbe no need to retrain HomeLink ifyour car’s battery goes dead or isdisconnected.

If your garage door opener wasmanufactured before April 1982, youmay not be able to programHomeLink to operate it. Garage dooropeners manufactured before thatdate do not have a safety feature thatcauses them to stop and reverse if anobstacle is detected during closing,increasing the risk of injury. If youhave questions, call (800) 355-3515.

HomeLink Universal Transceiver

Comfort and Convenience Features

Customer Assistance

Important Safety Precautions

General Information

157

00/12/25 14:19:11 31S0K630_160

Page 161: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If you are training the second orthird buttons, go directly to Step 1.

Unplug the garage door openermotor from the house current.

Before you can use HomeLink tooperate devices around your home, itmust ‘‘learn’’ the proper codes. Forexample, to train HomeLink to openand close the garage door:

If you just tookdelivery of your vehicle and have nottrained any of the buttons inHomeLink before, you should eraseany previously learned codes beforetraining the first button. To do this,press and hold the two outsidebuttons on the HomeLinktransceiver for about 20 seconds,until the red light flashes. Releasethe buttons, then proceed to Step 1.

Hold the end of the garage dooropener remote control 2 to 5inches from HomeLink. Makesure you are not blocking yourview of the red light in HomeLink.

Select the HomeLink button youwant to train.

Press the button on the remotecontrol and the button onHomeLink at the same time. Holddown both buttons.

2.

3.

4.1.

HomeLink Universal Transceiver

Comfort and Convenience Features

Training HomeLink Before you begin

158

00/12/25 14:19:21 31S0K630_161

Page 162: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

Canadian Owners:The remote control you are trainingfrom may stop transmitting after twoseconds. This is not long enough forHomeLink to learn the code. Releaseand press the button on the remotecontrol every two seconds untilHomeLink has learned the code.

For security purposes, newer garagedoor opening systems use a ‘‘rolling’’or variable code. Information fromthe remote control and the garagedoor opener are needed beforeHomeLink can operate the garagedoor opener.

The‘‘Training HomeLink’’ proceduretrains HomeLink to the propergarage door opener code. Thefollowing procedure synchronizesHomeLink to the garage door openerso they send and receive the correctcodes.

The red light in HomeLink shouldbegin flashing. It will flash slowlyat first, then rapidly.

When the red light flashes rapidly,release both buttons. HomeLinkshould have learned the code fromthe remote control.

Plug in the garage door openermotor, then test the HomeLinktransceiver button by pushing it. Itshould operate the garage door.

If the button does not work, repeatthis procedure to train it again. If itstill does not work, you may have a

variable or rolling code garagedoor opener. Test this by pressingand holding the HomeLinktransceiver button you just trained.If the red light blinks for twoseconds, then stays on, you have arolling code garage door opener.You may be able to verify this withthe manufacturer’s documentation.Go to ‘‘Training With a RollingCode System.’’

Repeat these steps to train theother two HomeLink buttons tooperate any other remotely-controlled devices around yourhome (lighting, automatic gate,security system, etc.).

5.

6.8.

7.

Training With a Rolling CodeSystem

HomeLink Universal Transceiver

Comfort and Convenience Features 159

00/12/25 14:19:32 31S0K630_162

Page 163: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

It may be helpful to have someoneassist you with this procedure.

Find the ‘‘Training’’ button on yourgarage door opener unit. Thelocation will vary, depending onthe manufacturer. Themanufacturer’s documentationmay help.

Press the Training button on thegarage door opener unit until thelight next to the button comes on,then release it. The light may blink,or come on and stay on. You thenhave approximately 30 seconds tocomplete the following steps.

Make sure you have properlycompleted the ‘‘TrainingHomeLink’’ procedure.

Press and release the button onHomeLink. (The same button youtrained with the ‘‘TrainingHomeLink’’ procedure.)

Press and release the HomeLinkbutton again. This should turn offthe training light on the garagedoor opener unit. (Some systemsmay require you to press andrelease the button up to threetimes.)

Press the HomeLink button again.It should operate the garage door.

6.

2.

4.

5.

1.

3.

HomeLink Universal Transceiver

Comfort and Convenience Features160

TTRRAAIINNIINNGG BBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:19:43 31S0K630_163

Page 164: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.

Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.

This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.

To erase the codes stored in all threebuttons, press and hold the twooutside buttons until the red lightbegins to flash, then release thebuttons.

You should erase all three codesbefore selling the car.

To train an already programmedHomeLink button to operate a newdevice:

Select the HomeLink button youwant to train.

Press and hold the HomeLinkbutton until the red light begins toflash slowly (approximately 20seconds).

While continuing to hold theHomeLink button, place theremote control for the device 2 to5 inches from HomeLink.

Release both buttons. HomeLinkshould now be trained to operatethe device.

Press and hold the button on theremote control. Hold both buttonsuntil the red light begins to flashrapidly.

1.

2.

3.

4.

5.Retraining a Button

Erasing Codes

HomeLink Universal Transceiver

Comfort and Convenience Features 161

00/12/25 14:19:56 31S0K630_164

Page 165: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

162

Page 166: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Before you begin driving your Acura,you should know what gasoline touse, and how to check the levels ofimportant fluids. You also need toknow how to properly store luggageor packages. The information in thissection will help you. If you plan toadd any accessories to your car,please read the information in thissection first.

.............................Break-in Period . 164.........................................Gasoline . 164

.........Service Station Procedures . 165................Filling the Fuel Tank . 165

....................Opening the Hood . 166...............................Oil Check . 168

.........Engine Coolant Check . 169...............................Fuel Economy . 170

.....................Vehicle Condition . 170...........................Driving Habits . 170

...Accessories and Modifications . 171.............................Carrying Cargo . 173

Before Driving

Before Driving 163

00/12/25 14:20:03 31S0K630_166

Page 167: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

During this period:

Avoid full-throttle starts and rapidacceleration.

Avoid hard braking. New brakesneed to be broken-in by moderateuse for the first 200 miles (300km).

Help assure your car’s futurereliability and performance by payingextra attention to how you driveduring the first 600 miles (1,000 km).

Do not change the oil until therecommended time or mileageinterval shown in the maintenanceschedule.

You should follow these same re-commendations with an overhauledor exchanged engine, or when thebrakes are relined.

In Canada, some gasolines containan octane-enhancing additive calledMMT. If you use such gasolines,your emissions control systemperformance may deteriorate andthe Malfunction Indicator Lamp onyour instrument panel may turn on.If this happens, contact yourauthorized Acura dealer for service.

Your Acura is designed to operate onpremium unleaded gasoline with apump octane number of 91 or higher.

Use of a lower octane gasoline cancause occasional, metallic knockingnoises in the engine and will result indecreased engine performance.

We recommend gasolines containingdetergent additives that help preventfuel system and engine deposits.

Using gasoline containing lead willdamage your car’s emissionscontrols. This contributes to airpollution.

Before Driving

Break-in Period Gasoline

Break-in Period, Gasoline

164

00/12/25 14:20:16 31S0K630_167

Page 168: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Because the fuel fill cap is on thedriver’s side of the car, park withthat side closest to the servicestation pumps.

Open the fuel fill door by pullingon the handle at the outside of thedriver’s seat.

Remove the fuel fill cap slowly.You may hear a hissing sound aspressure inside the tank escapes.Place the cap in the holder on thefuel fill door.

1.

2.

3.

CONTINUED

Filling the Fuel Tank

Service Station Procedures

Before Driving 165

FFUUEELL FFIILLLL CCAAPP

PPuullll

Gasoline is highly flammableand explosive. You can beburned or seriously injuredwhen handling fuel.

Stop the engine and keepheat, sparks, and flame away.Handle fuel only outdoors.Wipe up spills immediately.

00/12/25 14:20:26 31S0K630_168

Page 169: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Stop filling the tank after the fuelnozzle automatically clicks off. Donot try to ‘‘top off’’ the tank, leavesome room for the fuel to expandwith temperature changes.

Your car has an on-board refuelingvapor recovery system to helpkeep fuel vapors from going intothe atmosphere. If the fuel pumpkeeps clicking off even though thetank is not full, there may be aproblem with this system. Consultyour dealer.

Screw the fuel fill cap back on,tighten it until it clicks severaltimes. If you do not properlytighten the cap, the MalfunctionIndicator Lamp may come on (seepage ).

Push the fuel fill door closed untilit latches.

Shift to Park or Neutral and setthe parking brake. Pull the hoodrelease handle located under thelower left corner of the dashboard.The hood will pop up slightly.

4. 5.

6.

1.

293

Service Station Procedures

Before Driving

Opening the Hood

166

HHOOOODD RREELLEEAASSEE HHAANNDDLLEE

00/12/25 14:20:36 31S0K630_169

Page 170: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

Standing in front of the car, putyour fingers under the front edgeof the hood to the right of center.Slide your hand to the left untilyou feel the hood latch handle.Push this handle up until itreleases the hood. Lift the hood.

Lift the hood up most of the way.The hydraulic supports will lift itup the rest of the way and hold itup.

If you can open the hood withoutlifting the hood latch handle, orthe hood latch handle movesstiffly or does not spring back asbefore, the mechanism should becleaned and lubricated (see page

).

To close the hood, lower it to about afoot (30 cm) above the fender, thenpress down firmly with your hands.After closing the hood, make sure itis securely latched.

2. 3.

237

Service Station Procedures

Before Driving 167

LLAATTCCHH

00/12/25 14:20:46 31S0K630_170

Page 171: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Check the engine oil level every timeyou fill the car with fuel. Wait a fewminutes after turning the engine offbefore you check the oil.

Remove the dipstick (orangehandle).

Wipe the dipstick with a cleancloth or paper towel.

Insert it all the way back in its tube.

1.

2. 3.

Before Driving

Service Station Procedures

Oil Check

168

DDIIPPSSTTIICCKK

00/12/25 14:20:55 31S0K630_171

Page 172: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Remove the dipstick again andcheck the level. It should bebetween the upper and lowermarks.

If it is near or below the lower mark,see on page .

Look at the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. Make sure it isbetween the MAX and MIN lines. Ifit is below the MIN line, see

on page forinformation on adding the propercoolant.

Refer toon page for information

on checking other items in yourAcura.

4.

223

228

221

Service Station Procedures

Before Driving

Adding Oil

AddingEngine Coolant

Owner MaintenanceChecks

Engine Coolant Check

169

UUPPPPEERR MMAARRKK

LLOOWWEERR MMAARRKK

RREESSEERRVVEE TTAANNKK MMAAXX

MMIINN

00/12/25 14:21:05 31S0K630_172

Page 173: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

A cold engine uses more fuel than awarm engine. It is not necessary to‘‘warm-up’’ a cold engine by letting itidle for a long time. You can driveaway in about a minute, no matterhow cold it is outside. The enginewill warm up faster, and you getbetter fuel economy. To cut down onthe number of ‘‘cold starts,’’ try tocombine several short trips into one.

You can improve fuel economy bydriving moderately. Rapid acceler-ation, abrupt cornering, and hardbraking use more fuel.

Always drive in the highest gear thatallows the engine to run and acceler-ate smoothly.

Depending on traffic conditions, tryto maintain a constant speed. Everytime you slow down and speed up,your car uses extra fuel. Use thecruise control, when appropriate, toincrease fuel economy.

The condition of your car and yourdriving habits are the two mostimportant things that affect the fuelmileage you get.

Always maintain your car accordingto the maintenance schedule. Thiswill keep it in top operating condition.

An important part of that mainte-nance is the

(see page ). Forexample, an underinflated tirecauses more ‘‘rolling resistance,’’which uses fuel. It also wears outfaster, so check the tire pressure atleast monthly.

In winter, the build-up of snow onyour car’s underside adds weight androlling resistance. Frequent cleaninghelps your fuel mileage and reducesthe chance of corrosion.

The air conditioning puts an extraload on the engine which makes ituse more fuel. Turn off the A/C orset the climate control to a highertemperature to cut down on airconditioning use. Use the flow-through ventilation when the outsideair temperature is moderate.

221

Vehicle Condition

Driving Habits

Owner MaintenanceChecks

Before Driving

Fuel Economy

170

00/12/25 14:21:17 31S0K630_173

Page 174: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Be sure electronic accessories donot overload electrical circuits(see page ).

If possible, have your dealer inspectthe final installation.

Before installing any accessory:

Modifying your car, or installingsome non-Acura accessories, canmake your car unsafe. Before youmake any modifications or add anyaccessories, be sure to read thefollowing information.

Your dealer has Genuine Acuraaccessories that allow you topersonalize your car. Theseaccessories have been designed andapproved for your car, and arecovered by warranty.

Non-Acura accessories are usuallydesigned for universal applications.Although aftermarket accessoriesmay fit on your car, they may notmeet factory specifications, andcould adversely affect your car’shandling and stability. (See‘‘Modifications’’ on the page foradditional information.)

When properly installed, cellularphones, alarms, two-way radios, andlow-powered audio systems shouldnot interfere with your car’scomputer-controlled systems, suchas the SRS and anti-lock brakesystem.

Make sure the accessory does notobscure any lights, or interferewith proper car operation orperformance.

Have the installer contact yourAcura dealer for assistance beforeinstalling any electronic accessory.

However, if electronic accessoriesare improperly installed, or exceedyour car’s electrical system capacity,they can interfere with the operation

of your car, or even cause theairbags to deploy.

300

172

Accessories

Before Driving

Accessories and Modifications

171

Improper accessories ormodifications can affect yourcar’s handling, stability andperformance, and cause acrash in which you can be hurtor killed.

Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regardingaccessories and modifications.

00/12/25 14:21:29 31S0K630_174

Page 175: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

In addition, any modifications thatdecrease ground clearance increasethe chance of undercarriage partsstriking a curb, speed bump, or otherraised object, which could causeyour airbags to deploy.

Do not modify your steering wheelor any other part of yourSupplemental Restraint System.Modifications could make thesystem ineffective.

Do not remove any originalequipment or modify your car in anyway that would alter its design oroperation. This could make your carunsafe and illegal to drive.

For example, do not make anymodifications that would change theride height of your car, or installwheels and tires with a differentoverall diameter.

Such modifications can adverselyaffect handling, and interfere withthe operation of the car’s anti-lockbrakes and other systems.

If a side airbaginflates, a cup holder or other hardobject attached on or near thedoor could be propelled inside thecar and hurt someone.

Covering the outside edge of afront seat-back, with a non-Acuraseat cover for example, couldprevent the airbag from inflatingproperly.

Any objectattached to or placed on the coversmarked ‘‘SRS AIRBAG,’’ in thecenter of the steering wheel andon top of the dashboard, couldinterfere with the proper operationof the airbags. Or, if the airbagsinflate, the objects could bepropelled inside the car and hurtsomeone.

Modifications

Additional Safety Precautions

Accessories and Modifications

Before Driving

Do not attach hard objects on ornear a front door.

Do not place any objects over theoutside edge of a front seat-back.

Do not attach or place objects onthe front airbag covers.

172

00/12/25 14:21:41 31S0K630_175

Page 176: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Your car has several convenientstorage areas so you can stow cargosafely.

The glove box, and the pockets inthe front doors and seat-backs, aredesigned for small, lightweight items.The trunk is intended for larger,heavier items.In addition, the trunk pass-throughallows you to carry longer items.

However, carrying too much cargo,or improperly storing it, can affectyour car’s handling, stability andoperation and make it unsafe. Beforecarrying any type of cargo, be sure toread the following pages.

Carrying Cargo

Before Driving 173

FFRROONNTT DDOOOORR PPOOCCKKEETTCCOONNSSOOLLEE CCOOMMPPAARRTTMMEENNTT

GGLLOOVVEE BBOOXXTTRRUUNNKK SSEEAATT--BBAACCKK PPOOCCKKEETTSS

00/12/25 14:21:48 31S0K630_176

Page 177: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Store or secure all items that couldbe thrown around and hurtsomeone during a crash.

Be sure items placed on the floorbehind the front seats cannot rollunder the seats and interfere withthe driver’s ability to operate thepedals, or with the properoperation of the seats.

Keep the glove box closed whiledriving. If the lid is open, apassenger could injure their kneesduring a crash or sudden stop.

This figure includes the total weightof all occupants, cargo, accessories,and the tongue weight if you aretowing a trailer.

The final number is the total weightof cargo you can carry.

If you are towing a trailer, add thetongue weight to the numberabove.

Add up the weight of all occupants.

To figure out how much cargo youcan carry:

Do not put any items on top of therear shelf. They can block yourview and be thrown around the carduring a crash.

The maximum load for your car is850 lbs (395 kg).

Subtract the total from 850 lbs(395 kg).

Carrying Items in the PassengerCompartment

Load Limit

Carrying Cargo

Before Driving174

Overloading or improperloading can affect handling andstability and cause a crash inwhich you can be hurt or killed.

Follow all load limits and otherloading guidelines in thismanual.

00/12/25 14:22:03 31S0K630_177

Page 178: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Distribute cargo evenly on thefloor of the trunk, placing theheaviest items on the bottom andas far forward as possible.

If you can carry any items on aroof rack, be sure the total weightof the rack and the items does notexceed the maximum allowableweight. Please contact your Acuradealer for further information.

When you are not using the cargonet, store it in the pocket in the leftside of the trunk.

The cargo net can be used to helphold down items stored in the trunk.To use the cargo net, hook it to thebuttons on the floor and sides of thetrunk. You can use the cargo net inseveral configurations by hooking itto different buttons.

If you carry large items thatprevent you from closing the trunklid, exhaust gas can enter thepassenger area. To avoid thepossibility of carbon monoxidepoisoning, follow the instructionson page .53

Carrying Cargo in the Trunk or ona Roof Rack

Cargo Net

Carrying Cargo

Before Driving 175

TTRRUUNNKK NNEETT HHOOOOKK

CCAARRGGOO NNEETT

00/12/25 14:22:12 31S0K630_178

Page 179: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

176

Page 180: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

This section gives you tips onstarting the engine under variousconditions, and how to operate theautomatic transmission. It alsoincludes important information onparking your car, the braking system,the Traction Control System, andfacts you need if you are planning totow a trailer.

........................Preparing to Drive . 178.......................Starting the Engine . 179

Starting in Cold Weather....................at High Altitude . 179

..............Automatic Transmission . 180.Shift Lever Position Indicator . 180

................Shift Lever Positions . 181..............Engine Speed Limiter . 187

....................Shift Lock Release . 187...........................................Parking . 189

.....................The Braking System . 190.............Brake Wear Indicators . 190

...............Brake System Design . 191.......................Anti-lock Brakes . 191

Important Safety.........................Reminders . 192........................ABS Indicator . 192

..............Traction Control System . 193...............TCS ON/OFF Switch . 194

............................TCS Indicator . 195...Vehicle Stability Assist System . 196

...............Driving in Bad Weather . 199...........................Towing a Trailer . 201

Driving

Driving 177

00/12/25 14:22:19 31S0K630_180

Page 181: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Make sure all windows, mirrors,and outside lights are clean andunobstructed. Remove frost, snow,or ice.

Check that the hood and trunk arefully closed.

Check the adjustment of the seat(see page ).

Check the adjustment of theinside and outside mirrors (seepage ).

Check the adjustment of thesteering wheel (see page ).

Make sure the doors are securelyclosed and locked.

Fasten your seat belt. Check thatyour passengers have fastenedtheir seat belts (see page ).

Turn the ignition switch ON (II).Check the indicator lights in theinstrument panel.

Start the engine (see page ).

Check the gauges and indicatorlights in the instrument panel (seepage ).

Check that any items you may becarrying with you inside are storedproperly or fastened downsecurely.

Visually check the tires. If a tirelooks low, use a gauge to check itspressure.

You should do the following checksand adjustments every day beforeyou drive your car.

3.

2.

1.

4.

5.

6.

7.

8.

9.

11.

12.

10.

15

75 57

179

88

94

Preparing to Drive

Driving178

00/12/25 14:22:33 31S0K630_181

Page 182: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Apply the parking brake.

In cold weather, turn off allelectrical accessories to reducethe drain on the battery.

Make sure the shift lever is inPark. Press on the brake pedal.

Without touching the acceleratorpedal, turn the ignition key to theSTART (III) position. If the enginedoes not start right away, do nothold the key in START (III) formore than 15 seconds at a time.Pause for at least 10 secondsbefore trying again.

If the engine does not start within15 seconds, or starts but stallsright away, repeat step 4 with theaccelerator pedal pressed half-waydown. If the engine starts, releasepressure on the accelerator pedalso the engine does not race.

If the engine still does not start,press the accelerator pedal all theway down and hold it there whilestarting in order to clear flooding.As before, keep the ignition key inthe START (III) position for nomore than 15 seconds. Return tostep 5 if the engine does not start.If it starts, lift your foot off theaccelerator pedal so the enginedoes not race.

An engine is harder to start in coldweather. The thinner air found athigh altitude above 8,000 feet (2,400meters) adds to the problem.

Turn off all electrical accessoriesto reduce the drain on the battery.

Push the accelerator pedal half-way to the floor and hold it therewhile starting the engine. Do nothold the ignition key in START(III) for more than 15 seconds.When the engine starts, releasethe accelerator pedal gradually asthe engine speeds up and smoothsout.

If the engine fails to start in step 2,push the accelerator pedal to thefloor and hold it there while youtry to start the engine for no morethan 15 seconds. If the enginedoes not start, return to step 2.

Use the following procedure:

1.

2.

3.

4.

5.

6.

1.

2.

3.

Starting the Engine

Driving

Starting in Cold Weather at HighAltitude (Above 8,000 feet/2,400 meters)

179

00/12/25 14:22:47 31S0K630_182

Page 183: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Your Acura’s transmission has fiveforward speeds, and is electronicallycontrolled for smoother shifting. Italso has a ‘‘lock-up’’ torque converterfor better fuel economy. You mayfeel what seems like another shiftwhen the converter locks.

This indicator in the tachometershows which position the shift leveris in. The illuminated number next tothe ‘‘D ’’ indicator shows you thegear you have selected in theSequential SportShift mode.

The ‘‘D ’’ indicator comes on for afew seconds when you turn theignition switch ON (II). If it flasheswhile driving (in any shift position),it indicates a possible problem in thetransmission. Avoid rapidacceleration and have thetransmission checked by anauthorized Acura dealer as soon aspossible.

5

5

Driving

Automatic Transmission

Shift Lever Position Indicator

180

00/12/25 14:22:54 31S0K630_183

Page 184: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

The shift lever has nine positions. Itmust be in Park or Neutral to startthe engine. When you are stopped inD , D , D , 2, 1, N, R, or theSequential SportShift mode, pressfirmly on the brake pedal and keepyour foot off the accelerator pedal.

To select the Sequential SportShiftmode, slide the shift lever toward theleft from the ‘‘D ’’ position.In this mode the shift lever allowsyou to shift up and down manually.

You cannot shift out of Park with thebrake pedal depressed when theignition switch is in LOCK (0) orACCESSORY (I).

Whenever you move the shift lever,slide it along the guide on theconsole.

5 4 3

5

To shift from:P to R

R to NN to DD to DD to DD to 22 to 11 to 2

2 to DD to DD to DD to NN to RR to P

Do this:Press the brake pedal, thenmove the shift lever.

Move the lever.

5

5 4

4 3

3

3

3 4

4 5

5

Automatic Transmission

Driving

Shift Lever Positions

181

SSHHIIFFTT LLEEVVEERR

SSEEQQUUEENNTTIIAALLSSPPOORRTTSSHHIIFFTTMMOODDEEPPOOSSIITTIIOONN

00/12/25 14:23:05 31S0K630_184

Page 185: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

- -

- -

This position mechani-cally locks the transmission. UsePark whenever you are turning off orstarting the engine. To shift out ofPark, you must press on the brakepedal and have your foot off theaccelerator pedal. Move the shiftlever to the right to shift out of thePark position.

To avoid transmission damage, cometo a complete stop before shiftinginto Park. The shift lever must be inPark before you can remove the keyfrom the ignition switch.

To shift to Reversefrom Park, see the explanation underPark. To shift to Reverse fromNeutral, come to a complete stop andthen shift.

If you have done all of the above andstill cannot move the lever out ofPark, see Shift Lock Release on page

. If you cannot shift to Reverse whenthe car is stopped, press the brakepedal and slowly shift to Neutral, andthen to Reverse.

Your car has a reverse lockout soyou cannot accidentally shift toReverse from Neutral or any otherdriving position when the vehiclespeed exceeds 7 9 mph (12 14km/h).

If there is a problem in the reverselockout system, or your car’s batteryis disconnected or goes dead, youcannot shift to Reverse. (Refer toShift Lock Release on page ).

187

187

Automatic Transmission

Driving

Park (P) Reverse (R)

182

00/12/25 14:23:15 31S0K630_185

Page 186: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

++

--

CONTINUED

Use Neutral if youneed to restart a stalled engine, or ifit is necessary to stop briefly withthe engine idling. Shift to Park posi-tion if you need to leave the car forany reason. Press on the brake pedalwhen you are moving the shift leverfrom Neutral to another gear.

Use this position foryour normal driving. Thetransmission automatically selects asuitable gear for your speed andacceleration. You may notice thetransmission shifting up at higherspeeds when the engine is cold. Thishelps the engine warm up faster.

Withthe shift lever in ‘‘D ’’ position, youcan select the Sequential SportShiftmode to shift gears; much like amanual transmission, but without aclutch pedal.

To enter the Sequential SportShiftmode, move the shift lever to the left.To return to ‘‘D ’’, move the shiftlever to the right.

When you move the shift lever from‘‘D ’’ to the Sequential SportShiftmode, the display shows the selectedgear.

In the Sequential SportShift mode,each time you push forward on theshift lever, the transmission shifts toa higher gear. Pull back on the leverto downshift. The number of thegear selected is displayed next to the‘‘D ’’ indicator (see page ).

Even with the Sequential SportShiftMode selected, the transmission willautomatically upshift and downshiftbetween first and second gear.

180

5

5

5

5

Automatic Transmission

Driving

Neutral (N)

Drive (D )5

Sequential SportShift Mode

183

DDoowwnnsshhiifftt

UUppsshhiifftt

00/12/25 14:23:26 31S0K630_186

Page 187: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

When you accelerate away from astop, the transmission will start infirst gear and then automaticallyupshift to second gear. You have tomanually upshift between secondand fifth gears. Make sure youupshift before the engine speedreaches the tachometer’s red zone.

The transmission remains in theselected gear (5, 4, 3). There is noautomatic downshift when you pushthe accelerator pedal to the floor.

The transmission may automaticallydownshift from the higher gear tothe lower gear under the followingconditions:

To shift from

4 3

5 4

Speed range

under 18 mph(29 km/h)

under 34 mph(55 km/h)

To shift from

4 3

5 4

Speed range

under 34 mph(55 km/h)

under 47 mph(75 km/h)

The transmission will also shiftautomatically as the vehicle comes toa complete stop. It will downshift tofirst gear when the vehicle speed isunder 9 mph (15 km/h).

Downshifting gives you more powerwhen climbing or provides enginebraking when going down a steep hill.

If you try to manually downshift at aspeed that would cause the engine toexceed the redline in a lower gear,the transmission will not downshift.

The gear indicator will flash thenumber of the lower gear severaltimes, then return to the higher gear.

Driving on level roads and downhill

Driving uphill

Automatic Transmission

Driving184

00/12/25 14:23:38 31S0K630_187

Page 188: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

**

CONTINUED

If the car speed slows to below theredline of the selected lower gearposition while the indicator isflashing, the transmission willdownshift and the display will showthe selected lower gear.

If the transmission temperature isbelow 14 °F ( 10 °C), you may notbe able to use the SequentialSportShift mode.

The table shows the speed rangesfor upshifting and downshifting.

To shift from

2 3

3 4

4 5

Speed range

over 9 mph(15 km/h)

over 18 mph(29 km/h)

over 34 mph(55 km/h)

To shift from

3 2

4 3

5 4

Speed range

under 60 mph(96 km/h)under 65 mph(104 km/h)

under 93 mph(150 km/h)under 104 mph(166 km/h)

under 125 mph(200 km/h)

1

2

1

2

1 : Premium model2 : Type S

Automatic Transmission

Driving 185

00/12/25 14:23:48 31S0K630_188

Page 189: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

- -These positionsare similar to D , except when youselect the D position, only the firstfour gears are selected. When youselect D , only the first three gearsare selected. D can also keep thetransmission from cycling betweenfourth and fifth gears in stop-and-godriving, and D can keep thetransmission from cycling betweenthird and fourth gears.

Use D when towing a trailer in hillyterrain, or to provide engine brakingwhen going down a steep hill. Dgives you more power and increasedengine braking.

For faster acceleration when in D ,D or D , you can get thetransmission to automaticallydownshift by pushing the acceleratorpedal to the floor. The transmissionwill shift down one or two gears,depending on your speed.

This position locksthe transmission in second gear. Itdoes not downshift to first gearwhen you come to a stop. Secondgives you more power when climbing,and increased engine braking whengoing down steep hills. Use secondgear when starting out on a slipperysurface or in deep snow. It will helpreduce wheelspin.

54

34

3

3

3

34 5

Automatic Transmission

Driving

Drive (D , D ) Second (2)4 3

186

00/12/25 14:23:54 31S0K630_189

Page 190: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

-With the lever in thisposition, the transmission locks inFirst gear.

If you shift into First position whenthe vehicle speed is above 31 mph(50 km/h), the transmission shiftsinto Second gear first to avoidsudden engine braking.

If you exceed the maximum speedfor the gear you are in, the enginespeed will enter into the tachometer’sred zone. If this occurs, you may feelthe engine cut in and out. This iscaused by a limiter in the engine’scomputer controls. The engine willrun normally when you reduce theRPM below the red zone.

This allows you to move the shiftlever out of Park if the normalmethod of pushing on the brakepedal does not work. This procedurealso releases the Reverse Lockout.

Set the Parking brake.

Make sure the ignition switch is inthe OFF (0) position.

To release the Reverse Lockout,make sure the ignition switch is inthe ACCESSORY (I) position.

1.

2.

CONTINUED

Automatic Transmission

Driving

First (1) Engine Speed Limiter Shift Lock Release

187

00/12/25 14:24:06 31S0K630_190

Page 191: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Insert a screwdriver in the ShiftLock Release slot.

Push down on the screwdriver andmove the shift lever out of Park toNeutral.

To release the Reverse Lockout,move the shift lever from Neutralto Reverse, then Park.

Put a cloth on the edge of the ShiftLock Release slot cover next tothe shift lever.Use a small flat-tipped screwdriveror small metal plate (neither areincluded in the tool kit) to removethe cover. Carefully pry off theedge of the cover.

Remove the screwdriver from theShift Lock Release slot, thenreinstall the cover. Make sure thenotch on the cover is on the rightside. Depress the brake pedal andrestart the engine.

If you need to use the Shift LockRelease, it means your car isdeveloping a problem. Have the carchecked by your Acura dealer.

3.

6.

5.

4.

Automatic Transmission

Driving188

SSHHIIFFTT LLOOCCKK RREELLEEAASSEE SSLLOOTTCCOOVVEERR

00/12/25 14:24:16 31S0K630_191

Page 192: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Make sure the moonroof and thewindows are closed.

Place any packages, valuables, etc.,in the trunk or take them with you.

Turn off the lights.

Always use the parking brake whenyou park your car. The indicator onthe instrument panel shows that theparking brake is not fully released; itdoes not indicate that the parkingbrake is firmly set. Make sure theparking brake is set firmly or yourcar may roll if it is parked on anincline.

If the car is facing uphill, turn thefront wheels away from the curb.

If the car is facing downhill, turn thefront wheels toward the curb.

Make sure the parking brake is fullyreleased before driving away.Driving with the parking brakepartially set can overheat or damagethe rear brakes.Set the parking brake before you put

the transmission in Park. This keepsthe car from moving and puttingpressure on the parking mechanismin the transmission making iteasier to move the shift lever out ofPark when you want to drive away.

Lock the doors with the key or theremote transmitter. Check theindicator on the driver’s door toverify that the security system isset.

Never park over dry leaves, tallgrass, or other flammablematerials. The three way catalyticconverter gets very hot, and couldcause these materials to catch onfire.

Parking Tips

Parking

Driving 189

00/12/25 14:24:28 31S0K630_192

Page 193: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Put your foot on the brake pedal onlywhen you intend to brake. Restingyour foot on the pedal keeps thebrakes applied lightly, causing themto build up heat. Heat build-up canreduce how well your brakes work. Italso keeps your brake lights on allthe time, confusing drivers behindyou.

Constant application of the brakeswhen going down a long hill buildsup heat and reduces their effective-ness. Use the engine to assist thebrakes by downshifting to a lowergear and taking your foot off theaccelerator pedal.

Check your brakes after drivingthrough deep water. Apply thebrakes moderately to see if they feelnormal. If not, apply them gently andfrequently until they do. Since alonger distance is needed to stopwith wet brakes, be extra cautiousand alert in your driving.

Your Acura is equipped with discbrakes at all four wheels. A powerassist helps reduce the effort neededon the brake pedal. The ABS helpsyou retain steering control whenbraking very hard.

All four brakes have audible brakewear indicators.When the brake pads need replacing,you will hear a distinctive metallic‘‘screeching’’ sound when you applythe brakes. If you do not have thebrake pads replaced, they will beginscreeching all the time.

Your brakes may sometimes squealor squeak when you apply themlightly. Do not confuse this with thebrake wear indicators. They make avery audible ‘‘screeching.’’

Brake Wear Indicators

Driving

The Braking System

190

00/12/25 14:24:38 31S0K630_193

Page 194: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

this defeats thepurpose of the ABS. Let the ABSwork for you by always keeping firm,steady pressure on the brake pedalas you steer away from the hazard.This is sometimes referred to as

You will feel a pulsation in the brakepedal when the ABS activates, andyou may hear some noise. This isnormal, it is the ABS rapidlypumping the brakes.

Activation varies with the amount oftraction your tires have. On drypavement, you will need to press onthe brake pedal very hard before youactivate the ABS. However, you mayfeel the ABS activate immediately ifyou are trying to stop on snow or ice.

The hydraulic system that operatesthe brakes has two separate circuits.Each circuit works diagonally acrossthe vehicle (the left-front brake isconnected with the right-rear brake,etc.). If one circuit should develop aproblem, you will still have brakingat two wheels.

Your car has an Anti-lock BrakeSystem (ABS) as standardequipment. ABS helps to prevent thewheels from locking up and skiddingduring hard braking, allowing you toretain steering control.

When the front tires skid, you losesteering control; the car continuesstraight ahead even though you turnthe steering wheel. The ABS helps toprevent lock-up and helps you retainsteering control by pumping thebrakes rapidly; much faster than aperson can do it.

‘‘stomp and steer.’’

CONTINUED

Anti-lock Brakes You should never pump thebrake pedal,

Brake System Design

Driving

The Braking System

191

FFrroonntt

00/12/25 14:24:49 31S0K630_194

Page 195: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

**

**

it only helps with steeringcontrol during braking. You shouldalways maintain a safe followingdistance from other vehicles.

such as trying to take acorner too fast or making a suddenlane change. Always drive at a safe,prudent speed for the road andweather conditions. The ABS is self-checking. If anything

goes wrong, the ABS indicator onthe instrument panel comes on (seepage ). This means the anti-lockfunction of the braking system hasshut down. The brakes still work likea conventional system without anti-lock, providing normal stoppingability. You should have the dealerinspect your car as soon as possible.

Always steer moderatelywhen you are braking hard. Severeor sharp steering wheel movementcan still cause your car to veer intooncoming traffic or off the road.

on loose oruneven surfaces, such as gravel orsnow, than a vehicle without anti-lock. Slow down and allow a greaterdistance between vehicles underthose conditions.

60

Important Safety Reminders ABS IndicatorABS does not reduce the time ordistance it takes to stop thevehicle,

ABS will not prevent a skid thatresults from changing directionabruptly,

ABS cannot prevent a loss ofstability.

A vehicle with ABS may require alonger distance to stop

Driving

The Braking System

192

AABBSS IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

UU..SS.. iinnddiiccaattoorr sshhoowwnn

00/12/25 14:24:58 31S0K630_195

Page 196: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

When starting out or driving at lowspeeds on a loose or slippery roadsurface, you may notice that thevehicle does not respond to theaccelerator in the same way it doesat other times. This is a sign the TCSis activating. You will see the TCSindicator light flash.

Your Acura is equipped with aTraction Control System (TCS) toassist you in maintaining tractionwhile driving slowly on loose orslippery surfaces. The TCS assistsonly in low-speed, low-tractionconditions; up to approximately 18mph (30 km/h).

The TCS monitors the speed of allfour wheels. When it senses a frontwheel losing traction, it appliesbraking to that wheel. The TCSindicator flashes when this occurs.

Driving with TCS requires no specialskills or technique. The TCS doesnot control your car’s whole brakingsystem and cannot prevent skiddingif you enter a corner too fast. It isstill your responsibility to drive atreasonable speeds and to leave asufficient margin of safety.

Test your brakes as instructed onpage . If the brakes feel normal,drive slowly and have your carrepaired by your dealer as soon aspossible. Avoid sudden hard brakingwhich could cause the rear wheels tolock up and possibly lead to a loss ofcontrol.

The TCS indicator will come onalong with the ABS indicator.

The VSA system indicator may comeon along with the ABS indicator ifthere is a problem with the anti-lockbrake system.

295

CONTINUED

On Premium model

On Type S

On Premium model

Driving

Traction Control System

The Braking System, Traction Control System

193

TTCCSS IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

00/12/25 14:25:10 31S0K630_196

Page 197: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

You should still install winter tires onyour car during the winter. Makesure to use the same size originallysupplied with vehicle. Exercise thesame caution in winter driving as youwould if your car was not equippedwith TCS.

Driving with the compact spare tireinstalled (see page ) mayactivate the TCS. You should turn offthe system.

If the brakes overheat while the TCSis activating, the TCS indicator willstop flashing and stay on temporarily.This indicates that the TCS systemhas turned off. After the brakes havecooled down (usually for about 10minutes), the TCS will turn back onand the indicator will turn off.

This switch is under the side vent. Itlets you turn the Traction ControlSystem on and off. You cannot turnoff the TCS while the TCS indicatorlight is flashing.

Deactivate the system by pressingthe TCS On/Off switch. The TCSindicator light comes on as areminder. Pressing the switch againturns the system back on.

The Traction Control System turnson every time you start the engine,even if you turned it off the last timeyou drove the vehicle.278

Traction Control System

Driving

TCS ON/OFF Switch

194

00/12/25 14:25:20 31S0K630_197

Page 198: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If the TCS indicator comes on andstays on for more than 10 minuteswhile driving, pull to the side of theroad when it is safe and turn off theengine. Reset the system byrestarting the engine, and watch theTCS indicator. If the indicatorremains on, or comes back on whiledriving, have the system inspectedby your Acura dealer. You can stilldrive the vehicle without TCS.

This indicator will come on alongwith the ABS indicator if there is aproblem in the anti-lock brakesystem (see on page

).

The TCS indicator may occasionallycome on for one or two seconds andthen go out. This is normal.

The TCS indicator comes on orflashes under the following condi-tions:

When you turn the ignition switchto ON (II).

When you manually turn off theTCS.

It flashes when the TCS isregulating wheelspin.

If the system’s diagnostics sensesa problem in the TCS, the indica-tor will come on and stay on.

If the brakes overheat, theindicator will come on.

192

Traction Control System

Driving

ABS Indicator

TCS Indicator

195

00/12/25 14:25:31 31S0K630_198

Page 199: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The VSA system cannot enhance thecar’s driving stability in all situationsand does not control your vehicle’sentire braking system. It is still yourresponsibility to drive and corner atreasonable speeds and to leave asufficient margin of safety.

When VSA activates, you will see theVSA Activation indicator blink.

When VSA activates, you may noticethat the engine does not respond tothe accelerator in the same way itdoes at other times. You will also seethe VSA Activation Indicator blink.

The Vehicle Stability Assist systemhelps to stabilize the vehicle duringcornering if the car turns more orless than desired. It also assists youin maintaining traction whileaccelerating on loose or slipperyroad surfaces. It does this byregulating the engine’s output, andby selectively applying braking.

On Type S VSA Activation Indicator

Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System

Driving196

VVSSAA AACCTTIIVVAATTIIOONN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

00/12/25 14:25:39 31S0K630_199

Page 200: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If the VSA indicator comes on whiledriving, pull to the side of the roadwhen it is safe and turn off theengine. Reset the system byrestarting the engine, and watch theVSA system indicator. If theindicator remains on, or comes backon while driving, have the VSAsystem inspected by your Acuradealer.

When VSA is off, the VSA ActivationIndicator light comes on as areminder. Pressing the switch againturns the system back on.

If the indicator does not come onwhen the ignition switch is turnedON (II), there may be a problemwith the VSA system. Have yourdealer inspect your car as soon aspossible.

Without VSA, your car will havenormal braking and cornering ability,but it will not have VSA traction andstability enhancement.

This switch is under the left vent.Press it to turn the Vehicle StabilityAssist system on and off.

The VSA system indicator (see page) comes on and stays on when

there is a problem with the VSAsystem. The VSA Activationindicator will also come on.

61

CONTINUED

VSA System Indicator VSA Off Switch

Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System

Driving 197

VVSSAA SSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR VVSSAA OOFFFF SSWWIITTCCHH

00/12/25 14:25:52 31S0K630_200

Page 201: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

VSA is turned on every time youstart the engine, even if you turned itoff the last time you drove the car.

Driving with varying tire or wheelsizes may cause the VSA tomalfunction. When replacing tires,make sure they are of the same sizeand type as your original tires (seepage ).

Deactivate the VSA system if youneed to drive with the compact sparetire installed (see page ).

If you install winter tires, make surethey are the same size as those thatwere originally supplied with yourcar. Exercise the same cautionduring winter driving as you would ifyour car was not equipped with VSA.

254

278

VSA and Tire Sizes

Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System

Driving198

00/12/25 14:25:59 31S0K630_201

Page 202: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

- Exercise extra caution when drivingin rain after a long dry spell. Aftermonths of dry weather, the firstrains bring oil to the surface of theroadway, making it slippery.

Always driveslower than you would in dryweather. It takes your car longer toreact, even in conditions that mayseem just barely damp. Applysmooth, even pressure to all thecontrols. Abrupt steering wheelmovements or sudden, hard appli-cation of the brakes can cause loss ofcontrol in wet weather. Be extracautious for the first few miles(kilometers) of driving while youadjust to the change in drivingconditions. This is especially true insnow. A person can forget somesnow-driving techniques during thesummer months. Practice is neededto relearn those skills.

Rain, fog, and snow conditionsrequire a different driving techniquebecause of reduced traction andvisibility. Keep your car well-maintained and exercise greatercaution when you need to drive inbad weather. The cruise controlshould not be used in theseconditions.

Driving Technique

Driving in Bad Weather

Driving 199

00/12/25 14:26:05 31S0K630_202

Page 203: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

- -Being able to seeclearly in all directions and beingvisible to other drivers are importantin all weather conditions. This ismore difficult in bad weather. To beseen more clearly during daylighthours, turn on your headlights.

Check your tiresfrequently for wear and properpressure. Both are important inpreventing ‘‘hydroplaning’’ (loss oftraction on a wet surface). In thewinter, mount snow tires on all fourwheels for the best handling.

Watch road conditions carefully,they can change from moment tomoment. Wet leaves can be as slip-pery as ice. ‘‘Clear’’ roads can havepatches of ice. Driving conditionscan be very hazardous when theoutside temperature is near freezing.The road surface can becomecovered with areas of water puddlesmixed with areas of ice, so yourtraction can change without warning.

Be careful when downshifting. Iftraction is low, you can lock up thedrive wheels for a moment and causea skid.

Be very cautious when passing, orbeing passed by other vehicles. Thespray from large vehicles reducesyour visibility, and the wind buffetingcan cause you to lose control.

Inspect your windshield wipers andwashers frequently. Keep the wind-shield washer reservoir full of theproper fluid. Have the windshieldwiper blades replaced if they start tostreak the windshield or leave partsunwiped. Use the defroster and airconditioning to keep the windowsfrom fogging up on the inside (seepages and ).122 127

Visibility Traction

Driving in Bad Weather

Driving200

00/12/25 14:26:14 31S0K630_203

Page 204: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Your Acura has been designedprimarily to carry passengers andtheir cargo. You can use it to tow atrailer if you carefully observe theload limits, use the proper equipment,and follow the guidelines in thissection.

The totalweight of the trailer andeverything loaded in it must notexceed 1,000 lbs (450 kg). Towinga load that is too heavy canseriously affect your vehicle’shandling and performance. It canalso damage the engine anddrivetrain.

The weight thatthe tongue of a fully-loaded trailerputs on the hitch should beapproximately 10 percent of thetrailer weight. Too little tongueload can make the trailer unstableand cause it to sway. Too muchtongue load reduces front-tiretraction and steering control.

CONTINUED

Load Limits

Total Trailer Weight: Tongue Load:

Towing a Trailer

Driving 201

00/12/25 14:26:24 31S0K630_204

Page 205: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The total weight of the vehicle, alloccupants, all cargo, thetongue load must not exceed:

To achieve a proper tongue load,start by loading 60 percent of theload toward the front of the trailerand 40 percent toward the rear, thenre-adjust the load as needed.

The total weight of the vehicle, alloccupants, all cargo, and thetongue load must not exceed:

on the front axle

on the rear axle

on the front axle

on the rear axle

and

Premium model

Type S

Premium model

Type S

Gross Vehicle Weight Rating(GVWR):

Gross Axle Weight Rating(GAWR):

Towing a Trailer

Driving202

4,400 lbs (1,995 kg)

2,425 lbs (1,100 kg)

2,050 lbs (930 kg)

4,475 lbs (2,030 kg)

2,470 lbs (1,120 kg)

2,050 lbs (930 kg)

Exceeding load limits orimproperly loading your vehicleand trailer can cause a crash inwhich you can be seriouslyinjured or killed.

Check the loading of yourvehicle and trailer carefullybefore starting to drive.

00/12/25 14:26:33 31S0K630_205

Page 206: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Any hitch used on your vehicle mustbe properly bolted to the underbody.

Towing can require a variety ofequipment, depending on the size ofyour trailer, how it will be used, andhow much load you are towing.

Discuss your needs with your trailersales or rental agency, and follow theguidelines in the rest of this section.Also make sure that all equipment isproperly installed and that it meetsfederal, state, province, and localregulations.

The best way to confirm that vehicleand trailer weights are within limitsis to have them checked at a publicscale.

Using a suitable scale or a specialtongue load gauge, check the tongueload the first time you set up atowing combination (a fully-loadedvehicle and trailer), then recheck thetongue load whenever the conditionschange.

Always use safety chains. Make surethey are secured to both the trailerand hitch, and that they cross underthe tongue so they can catch thetrailer if it becomes unhitched.Leave enough slack to allow thetrailer to turn corners easily, but donot let the chains drag on the ground.

CONTINUED

Hitches

Safety ChainsTowing Equipment andAccessories

Checking Loads

Towing a Trailer

Driving 203

00/12/25 14:26:44 31S0K630_206

Page 207: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If you choose electric brakes, besure they are electronically actuated.Do not attempt to tap into yourvehicle’s hydraulic system. Nomatter how successful it may seem,any attempt to attach trailer brakesto your vehicle’s hydraulic systemwill lower braking effectiveness andcreate a potential hazard.

Since lighting and wiring vary intrailer type and brand, you shouldalso have a qualified mechanic installa suitable connector between thevehicle and the trailer.

If you use a converter, you can getthe connector and pins that matewith the connector in your car fromyour Acura dealer.

Your car has a trailer lightingconnector located in the trunk by theleft taillight. To use the connector,undo the fastener and unscrew thecargo net mounting button on theleft side of the trunk lining. Refer tothe drawing in this page for thewiring color code and purpose ofeach pin.

Acura recommends that any trailerhaving a total weight of 1,000 lbs(450 kg) or more be equipped withits own electric or surge-type brakes.

Trailer Brakes Trailer Lights

Driving

Towing a Trailer

204

GGRROOUUNNDD((BBLLAACCKK))

BBAACCKK--UUPP LLIIGGHHTT((GGRREEEENN//BBLLAACCKK))

LLEEFFTT TTUURRNN SSIIGGNNAALL((GGRREEEENN//BBLLUUEE))

RRIIGGHHTT TTUURRNN SSIIGGNNAALL((GGRREEEENN//YYEELLLLOOWW))

TTAAIILLLLIIGGHHTT((RREEDD//BBLLAACCKK))

BBRRAAKKEE LLIIGGHHTT((WWHHIITTEE//BBLLAACCKK))

00/12/25 14:26:54 31S0K630_207

Page 208: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

When preparing to tow, and beforedriving away, be sure to check thefollowing:

The vehicle has been properlyserviced, and the tires, brakes,suspension, and cooling systemare in good operating condition.

All weights and loads are withinlimits (see pages and ).

All items on and in the trailer areproperly secured and cannot shiftwhile you drive.

Many states and Canadian provincesrequire special outside mirrors whentowing a trailer. Even if they don’t,you should install special mirrors ifyou cannot clearly see behind you, orif the trailer creates a blind spot.

Ask your trailer sales or rentalagency if any other items arerecommended or required for yourtowing situation.

The lights and brakes on yourvehicle and the trailer are workingproperly.

Your vehicle tires and spare areproperly inflated (see page ),and the trailer tires and spare areinflated as recommended by thetrailer maker.

The hitch, safety chains, and anyother attachments are secure.

201 202

252

Pre-Tow ChecklistAdditional Trailer Equipment

Towing a Trailer

Driving 205

00/12/25 14:27:07 31S0K630_208

Page 209: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

--

--

The added weight, length, andheight of a trailer will affect yourvehicle’s handling and performance,so driving with a trailer requiressome special driving skills andtechniques.

For your safety and the safety ofothers, take time to practice drivingmaneuvers before heading for theopen road, and follow the guidelinesdiscussed below.

Make turns more slowly and widerthan normal. The trailer tracks asmaller arc than your vehicle, and itcan hit or run over something thevehicle misses. Allow more time anddistance for braking. Do not brake orturn suddenly as this could cause thetrailer to jackknife or turn over.

When climbing hills, closely watchyour temperature gauge. If it nearsthe red (Hot) mark, turn the airconditioning off, reduce speed and, ifnecessary, pull to the side of theroad to let the engine cool.

If the transmission shifts frequentlybetween 4th and 5th gears whilegoing up a hill, shift to D . And if thetransmission shifts frequentlybetween 3rd and 4th gears, shift toD .

Drive slower than normal in alldriving situations, and obey postedspeed limits for vehicles with trailers.Use the D or D position whentowing a trailer on level roads. D isthe proper shift lever position to usewhen towing a trailer in hilly terrain.(See ‘‘ ’’ in thefollowing column for additional gearinformation.)

When towing a trailer in theSequential SportShift mode, selectFourth, Third, Second, or First gear;depending on the vehicle speeds androad condition. Do not use Fifth gear.The recommended speed range foreach gear position is shown in thetable.

Gear position

1

2

3, 4

Speed range

0 37 mph(0 60 km/h)

12 68 mph

over 25 mph(over 40 km/h)

4

3

5 43

(20 110 km/h)

Driving Safely With a Trailer

Towing Speeds and Gears

Making Turns and Braking

Driving on Hills

Driving on Hills

Towing a Trailer

Driving206

00/12/25 14:27:21 31S0K630_209

Page 210: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Follow all normal precautions whenparking, including putting thetransmission in Park and firmlysetting the parking brake. Also, placewheel chocks at each of the trailer’stires.

Crosswinds and air turbulencecaused by passing trucks can disruptyour steering and cause trailerswaying. When being passed by alarge vehicle, keep a constant speedand steer straight ahead. Do not tryto make quick steering or brakingcorrections.

Always drive slowly and havesomeone guide you when backing up.Grip the of the steeringwheel; then turn the wheel to the leftto get the trailer to move to the left,and turn the wheel right to move thetrailer to the right.

If you must stop when facing uphill,use the foot brake or parking brake.Do not try to hold the vehicle inplace by pressing on the accelerator,as this can cause the automatictransmission to overheat.

When driving down hills, reduceyour speed and shift down to 2ndgear. Do not ‘‘ride’’ the brakes, andremember it will take longer to slowdown and stop when towing a trailer.

bottom

ParkingHandling Crosswinds and Buffeting

Backing Up

Towing a Trailer

Driving 207

00/12/25 14:27:31 31S0K630_210

Page 211: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

208

Page 212: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

This section also includesMaintenance Schedules for normaldriving and severe driving conditions,a Maintenance Record, and instruc-tions for simple maintenance tasksyou may want to take care ofyourself.

This section explains why it isimportant to keep your car wellmaintained and to follow basicmaintenance safety precautions.

If you have the skills and tools to per-form more complex maintenancetasks on your Acura, you may wantto purchase the Service Manual. Seepage for information on how toobtain a copy, or see your Acuradealer.

......................Maintenance Safety . 210.Important Safety Precautions . 211

.................Maintenance Schedule . 212...Required Maintenance Record . 219

.......Owner Maintenance Checks . 221..............................Fluid Locations . 222

......................................Engine Oil . 223..................................Adding Oil . 223

....................Recommended Oil . 223..............................Synthetic Oil . 224

....................................Additives . 225.....Changing the Oil and Filter . 225

.............................Cooling System . 228............Adding Engine Coolant . 228

.......Replacing Engine Coolant . 230....................Windshield Washers . 233

....Automatic Transmission Fluid . 234....................................Brake Fluid . 236

............................Brake System . 236..............................Power Steering . 237

....................................Hood Latch . 237.....................Air Cleaner Element . 238

....................................Spark Plugs . 240..............................Replacement . 240............................Specifications . 242

...........................................Battery . 243

.................................Wiper Blades . 246..............Air Conditioning System . 248

.................Air Conditioning Filter . 249.....................................Drive Belts . 249....................................Timing Belt . 250

...............................................Tires . 250......................................Inflation . 251

..................................Inspection . 252..............................Maintenance . 253.............................Tire Rotation . 254

...Replacing Tires and Wheels . 254......................Wheels and Tires . 255

..........................Winter Driving . 256.............................Snow Tires . 256

...................Traction Devices . 256.............................................Lights . 257

.....................Headlight Aiming . 259........................Replacing Bulbs . 259

...........................Storing Your Car . 267325

Maintenance

Maintenance 209

00/12/25 14:27:41 31S0K630_212

Page 213: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Some of the most important safetyprecautions are given here. However,we cannot warn you of everyconceivable hazard that can arise inperforming maintenance. Only youcan decide whether or not youshould perform a given task.

Regularly maintaining your car is thebest way to protect your investment.Proper maintenance is essential toyour safety and the safety of yourpassengers. It will also reward youwith more economical, trouble-freedriving and help reduce air pollution.

This section includes instructions forsimple maintenance tasks, such aschecking and adding oil. Any serviceitems not detailed in this sectionshould be performed by an Acuratechnician or other qualifiedmechanic.

Maintenance Safety

Maintenance210

Failure to properly followmaintenance instructions andprecautions can cause you tobe seriously hurt or killed.

Always follow the proceduresand precautions in this owner’smanual.

Improperly maintaining this caror failing to correct a problembefore driving can cause acrash in which you can beseriously hurt or killed.

Always follow the inspectionand maintenancerecommendations andschedules in this owner’smanual.

00/12/25 14:27:47 31S0K630_213

Page 214: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Be surethere is adequate ventilationwhenever you operate the engine.

Let theengine and exhaust system coolbefore touching any parts.

Donot run the engine unless in-structed to do so.

Read the instructions before youbegin, and make sure you have thetools and skills required.

Before you begin any maintenance,make sure your car is parked onlevel ground and that the parkingbrake is set. Also, be sure the engineis off. This will help to eliminateseveral potential hazards:

To reduce the possibility of fire orexplosion, be careful when workingaround gasoline or batteries. Use acommercially available degreaser orparts cleaner, not gasoline, to cleanparts. Keep cigarettes, sparks, andflames away from the battery and allfuel-related parts.

You should wear eye protection andprotective clothing when workingnear the battery or when usingcompressed air.

Maintenance Safety

Maintenance

Important Safety Precautions

Carbon monoxide poisoningfrom engine exhaust.

Burns from hot parts.

Injury from moving parts.

211

00/12/25 14:27:57 31S0K630_214

Page 215: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The services and time or distanceintervals shown in the maintenanceschedule assume you will use yourvehicle as normal transportation forpassengers and their possessions.You should also follow theserecommendations:

The Maintenance Schedule specifieshow often you should have your carserviced and what things needattention. It is essential that you haveyour car serviced as scheduled toretain its high level of safety,dependability, and emissions controlperformance.

Avoid exceeding your car’s loadlimit. This puts excess stress onthe engine, brakes, and manyother parts of your car. The loadlimit is shown on the label on thedriver’s doorjamb.

Operate your car on reasonableroads within the legal speed limit.

Service your car according to thetime and mileage periods on one ofthe Maintenance Schedules on thefollowing pages. Select the schedulefor ‘‘Severe Conditions’’ if most ofyour driving is done under one ormore of the conditions listed on thatpage. Otherwise, follow the schedulefor ‘‘Normal Conditions.’’

Drive your car regularly over adistance of several miles(kilometers).

Always use unleaded gasoline withthe proper octane rating (see page

).164

Maintenance Schedule

Maintenance

Which Schedule to Follow:

212

00/12/25 14:28:06 31S0K630_215

Page 216: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

According to state and federalregulations, failure to performmaintenance on the items markedwith will not void your emissionswarranties. However, Acurarecommends that all maintenanceservices be performed at therecommended time or mileageperiod to ensure long-term reliability.U.S. Cars:

We recommend the use of genuineAcura parts and fluids whenever youhave maintenance done. These aremanufactured to the same high-quality standards as the originalcomponents, so you can be confidentof their performance and durability.

Your authorized Acura dealer knowsyour car best and can providecompetent, efficient service.However, service at a dealer is notmandatory to keep your warrantiesin effect. Maintenance may be doneby any qualified service facility orperson who is skilled in this type ofautomotive service. Keep all thereceipts as proof of completion, andhave the person who does the workfill out the Maintenance Record.Check your warranty booklet formore information.

Maintenance Schedule

Maintenance

Maintenance, replacement orrepair of emissions controldevices and systems may be doneby any automotive repairestablishment or individual usingparts that are ‘‘certif ied’’ to EPAstandards.

213

00/12/25 14:28:14 31S0K630_216

Page 217: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Follow the Normal ConditionsMaintenance Schedule if thesevere driving conditionsspecified in the SevereConditions MaintenanceSchedule do not apply.

NOTE: If you onlydrive under a

‘‘severe’’ condition, you shouldfollow the Normal ConditionsMaintenance Schedule.

Follow the MaintenanceSchedule for Severe Conditions.

OCCASIONALLY

Maintenance

U.S. Owners

Canadian Owners

214

Visually inspect the following items:

Service at the indicateddistance or time whichevercomes first.

miles x 1,000km x 1,000months

Replace every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 12 months

Check oil and coolant at each fuel stop

Replace engine oilReplace engine oil filterCheck engine oil and coolantReplace air cleaner elementInspect valve clearanceReplace spark plugsReplace timing belt, and inspect water pumpInspect and adjust drive beltsInspect idle speedReplace engine coolant

Replace transmission fluid

Inspect front and rear brakesReplace brake fluidCheck parking brake adjustmentReplace air conditioning filterRotate tires (Check tire inflation and conditionat least once per month)

Tie rod ends, steering gear box, and bootsSuspension componentsDriveshaft bootsBrake hoses and lines (including ABS)All fluid levels and condition of fluidsCooling system hoses and connectionsExhaust systemFuel lines and connections

Rotate tires every 7,500 miles (12,000 km)

152412

304824

609648

12019296

7512060

10516884

457236

9014472

Every 36 months (independent of mileage)

See information on maintenance and emissions warranty, last column, page .

120,000 miles (192,000 km) or 72 months, then every90,000 miles (144,000 km) or 60 months

120,000 miles (192,000 km) or 120 months, then every 60,000miles (96,000 km) or 60 months

:

Adjust only if noisy

213

Maintenance

ScheduleforN

ormalConditions

00/12/25 14:28:36 31S0K630_217

Page 218: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

--

□□□□

□□□□□□□□□□

□□□□□□□

Maintenance 215

U.S. Owners

Canadian Owners

A, B, C, D

A

B

C

D

Refer to page to determine which schedule to use.Use the Maintenance Schedule for Severe Conditions.

Service at the indicated distance or time, whichever comes first. Do the items in as required for each distance/time interval.

Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.Do items in A, B, C.Do items in A.Do items in A, B, D.Do items in A.Do items in A, B, C.Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.Do items in A, B, C, D.Do items in A.

Replace timing belt, and inspect water pump.Inspect valve clearance.Check idle speed.Replace spark plugs.

Do items in A, B.Do items in A.Do items in A, B, C.

Replace engine coolant, then replaceevery 60,000 mi/96,000 km/5 yrs.

Replace transmission fluid, then replaceevery 90,000 mi/144,000 km/5 yrs.

7,500 mi/12,000 km15,000 mi/24,000 km/1 yr22,500 mi/36,000 km30,000 mi/48,000 km/2 yrs37,500 mi/60,000 km45,000 mi/72,000 km/3 yrs52,500 mi/84,000 km60,000 mi/96,000 km/4 yrs67,500 mi/108,000 km75,000 mi/120,000 km/5 yrs82,500 mi/132,000 km90,000 mi/144,000 km/6 yrs97,500 mi/156,000 km105,000 mi/168,000 km/7 yrs

112,500 mi/180,000 km120,000 mi/192,000 km/8 yrs120,000 mi/192,000 km/10 yrs

120,000 mi/192,000 km/6 yrs

Replace engine oil.Rotate tires (follow pattern on page 254 ).Replace engine oil filter.Inspect front and rear brakes.Check parking brake adjustment.Inspect tie rod ends, steering gear box and boots.Inspect suspension components.Inspect driveshaft boots.Inspect brake hoses and lines (including ABS).Check all fluid levels, condition of fluids, and checkfor leaks.Inspect cooling system hoses and connections.Inspect exhaust system.Inspect fuel lines and connections.

Replace air cleaner element.Inspect and adjust drive belts.Replace air conditioning filter.Replace brake fluid every 3 years(independent of mileage).

214

See information on maintenance and emissions warranty, lastcolumn, page .

Check engine oil and coolant at each fuel stop.Check and adjust valve clearance, cold engine, only if noisy.

NOTE:

:213

Maintenance

Schedule

forNorm

alConditions

(listedby

distance/time)

00/12/25 14:28:46 31S0K630_218

Page 219: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

***

#Driving less than 5 miles (8km) per trip or, in freezingtemperatures, driving lessthan 10 miles (16 km) per trip.Driving in extremely hot[over 90°F (32°C)] conditions.Extensive idling or longperiods of stop-and-go driving.Trailer towing, driving with aroof rack, or driving inmountainous conditions.Driving on muddy, dusty, orde-iced roads.

Follow the MaintenanceSchedule for Severe Conditions.

Follow the Severe ConditionsMaintenance Schedule if youdrive your car underone or more of the followingconditions:

MAINLY

Maintenance

U.S. Owners

Canadian Owners

216

Visually inspect the following items:

Service at the indicateddistance or time whichevercomes first.

miles x 1,000km x 1,000months

Replace every 3,750 miles (6,000 km) or 6 monthsCheck oil and coolant at each fuel stop

See Air Conditioning Filter on page for replacement information under special driving conditions.

Tie rod ends, steering gear box, and bootsSuspension componentsDriveshaft bootsBrake hoses and lines (including ABS)All fluid levels and conditions of fluidsCooling system hoses and connectionsExhaust systemFuel lines and connections

Lights and controls, Vehicle underbody

Rotate tires every 7,500 miles (12,000 km)

Inspect every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months

Every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months

Every 36 months (independent of mileage)

See Timing Belt on page for replacement information under special driving conditions.

152412

304824

457236

609648

7512060

9014472

10516884

12019296

120,000 miles (192,000 km) or 120 months, then every 60,000miles (96,000 km) or 60 months

60,000 miles (96,000 km) or 36 months, then every30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 24 months

Replace engine oil and oil filterCheck engine oil and coolantClean ( ) or replace ( ) air cleaner element

Inspect valve clearanceReplace spark plugs

Inspect and adjust drive beltsInspect idle speedReplace engine coolant

Replace transmission fluid

Inspect front and rear brakesReplace brake fluidCheck parking brake adjustmentReplace air conditioning filterLubricate all hinges, locks and latchesRotate tires (Check tire inflation and conditionat least once per month)

See information on maintenance and

emissions warranty, last column, page

.

Adjust only if noisy

250249

:

213

1 :2 :3 :

Premium model only

1

2

3

Use normal schedule except in dusty conditons

Replace timing belt , and inspect water pump

Maintenance

ScheduleforSevereConditions

00/12/25 14:29:11 31S0K630_219

Page 220: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

--

□□□□□□□□

□□

□□□□□□□□□

# *

***

CONTINUEDMaintenance 217

A, B, C, D, E

U.S. Owners

Canadian Owners

A

B

C

D

E

Service at the indicated distance or time, whichever comes first. Do the items in as required for each distance/time.Refer to page to determine which schedule to use.

Use the Maintenance Schedule for Severe Conditions.

Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.

Clean air cleaner element.Do items in A, B, C.Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.Do items in A, B, C, D.Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.

Clean air cleaner element.Do items in A, B, C, E.Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.

Replace timing belt , and inspect water pump.Do items in A, B, C, D.

Replace transmission fluid.Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.

Clean air cleaner element.Do items in A, B, C.Do items in A.

3,750 mi/6,000 km7,500 mi/12,000 km11,250 mi/18,000 km15,000 mi/24,000 km/1 yr

18,750 mi/30,000 km22,500 mi/36,000 km26,250 mi/42,000 km30,000 mi/48,000 km/2 yrs33,750 mi/54,000 km37,500 mi/60,000 km41,250 mi/66,000 km45,000 mi/72,000 km/3 yrs

48,750 mi/78,000 km52,500 mi/84,000 km56,250 mi/90,000 km60,000 mi/96,000 km/4 yrs

60,000 mi/96,000 km/3 yrs63,750 mi/102,000 km67,500 mi/108,000 km71,250 mi/114,000 km75,000 mi/120,000 km/5 yrs

78,750 mi/126,000 km

Replace engine oil and filter.Inspect front and rear brakes.Rotate tires (follow pattern on page 254 ).Inspect tie rod ends, steering gear box and boots.Inspect suspension components.Inspect driveshaft boots.Check parking brake adjustment.Lubricate all hinges, locks and latches withmultipurpose grease.Inspect brake hoses and lines (including ABS).Check all fluid levels, condition of fluids, and checkfor leaks.Inspect cooling system hoses and connections.Inspect exhaust system.Inspect fuel lines and connections.

Check all lights.Inspect the underbody.Replace air cleaner element.Inspect and adjust drive belts.Replace air conditioning filter .Replace brake fluid every 3 years(independent of mileage).

216

See information on maintenance and emissions warranty, lastcolumn, page .

See Timing Belt on page for replacement information under special driving conditions.See Air Conditioning Filter on page for replacement information under special drivingconditions.

Check engine oil and coolant at each fuel stop.Check and adjust valve clearance, cold engine, only if noisy.

NOTE:

213

250

:

Premium model only1 :2 :3 : 249

1

1

2

1

3

Maintenance

Schedule

forSevere

Conditions

(listedby

distance/time)

00/12/25 14:29:24 31S0K630_220

Page 221: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

□□□□□

**

Maintenance218

See information on maintenance and emissions warranty, lastcolumn, page .

Check engine oil and coolant at each fuel stop.Check and adjust valve clearance, cold engine, only if noisy.

See Air Conditioning Filter on page for replacementinformation under special driving conditions.

See Timing Belt on page for replacement information underspecial driving conditions.

NOTE:

213

250

:

1 :2 :

3 : 249

Premium model only

82,500 mi/132,000 km86,250 mi/138,000 km90,000 mi/144,000 km/6 yrs90,000 mi/144,000 km/5 yrs93,750 mi/150,000 km97,500 mi/156,000 km101,250 mi/162,000 km105,000 mi/168,000 km/7 yrs

108,750 mi/174,000 km112,500 mi/180,000 km116,250 mi/186,000 km120,000 mi/192,000 km/8 yrs

120,000 mi/192,000 km/10 yrs

120,000 mi/192,000 km/7 yrs

Do items in A, B.Do items in A.Do items in A, B, C, D, E.

Replace transmission fluid.Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.

Replace timing belt , and inspect water pump.Check idle speed.Clean air cleaner element.Replace spark plugs.Inspect valve clearance.

Do items in A, B, C.Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.

Replace timing belt , and inspect water pump.Do items in A, B, C, D.

Replace engine coolant, then replaceevery 60,000 mi/96,000 km/5 yrs.

Replace transmission fluid.

2

1

2

Maintenance

ScheduleforSevereConditions

(listed

bydistance/time)

00/12/25 14:29:32 31S0K630_221

Page 222: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUEDMaintenance

Required Maintenance Record (for Normal and Severe Schedules)

219

3,750 mi

7,500 mi

11,250 mi

15,000 mi

18,750 mi

22,500 mi

26,250 mi

30,000 mi

33,750 mi

37,500 mi

41,250 mi

45,000 mi

48,750 mi

52,500 mi

56,250 mi

60,000 mi

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

Signature or dealer stamp Signature or dealer stamp mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

You or the servicing dealer can record all completed maintenance here, whether you follow the schedule for normal conditions (page ) or severeconditions (page ). Keep the receipts for all work done on your car.

6,000 km

12,000 km

18,000 km

24,000 km(or 1 year)

30,000 km

36,000 km

42,000 km

48,000 km(or 2 years)

54,000 km

60,000 km

66,000 km

72,000 km(or 3 years)

78,000 km

84,000 km

90,000 km

96,000 km(or 4 years)

214216

00/12/25 14:29:41 31S0K630_222

Page 223: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Maintenance

Required Maintenance Record (for Normal and Severe Schedules)

220

63,750 mi

67,500 mi

71,250 mi

75,000 mi

78,750 mi

82,500 mi

86,250 mi

90,000 mi

93,750 mi

97,500 mi

101,250 mi

105,000 mi

108,750 mi

112,500 mi

116,250 mi

120,000 mi

Signature or dealer stamp mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

Signature or dealer stamp mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

mi/km

Date

102,000 km

108,000 km

114,000 km

120,000 km(or 5 years)

126,000 km

132,000 km

138,000 km

144,000 km(or 6 years)

150,000 km

156,000 km

162,000 km

168,000 km(or 7 years)

174,000 km

180,000 km

186,000 km

192,000 km(or 8 years)

00/12/25 14:29:49 31S0K630_223

Page 224: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

You should check the followingitems at the specified intervals. Ifyou are unsure of how to performany check, turn to the page given.

Engine oil level Check everytime you fill the fuel tank. Seepage .

Engine coolant level Check theradiator reserve tank every timeyou fill the fuel tank. See page .

Windshield washer fluid Checkthe level in the reservoir monthly.If weather conditions cause you touse the washers frequently, checkthe reservoir each time you stopfor fuel. See page .

Lights Check the operation ofthe headlights, parking lights,taillights, high-mount brake light,turn signals, brake lights, andlicense plate lights monthly. Seepage .

Tires Check the tire pressuremonthly. Examine the tread forwear and foreign objects. See page

.

Automatic transmission Checkthe fluid level monthly. See page

.

Brakes Check the fluid levelmonthly. See page .

168

169

233

234

236

250

257

Owner Maintenance Checks

Maintenance 221

00/12/25 14:30:01 31S0K630_224

Page 225: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Maintenance

Fluid Locations

222

RRAADDIIAATTOORR CCAAPP

EENNGGIINNEE OOIILLFFIILLLL CCAAPP

EENNGGIINNEE OOIILL DDIIPPSSTTIICCKK((OOrraannggee lloooopp))

WWAASSHHEERR FFLLUUIIDD((BBlluuee ccaapp))

PPOOWWEERR SSTTEEEERRIINNGGFFLLUUIIDD ((RReedd ccaapp))

BBRRAAKKEE FFLLUUIIDD((GGrraayy ccaapp))

AAUUTTOOMMAATTIICCTTRRAANNSSMMIISSSSIIOONNFFLLUUIIDD DDIIPPSSTTIICCKK((YYeellllooww lloooopp))

EENNGGIINNEECCOOOOLLAANNTTRREESSEERRVVOOIIRR

00/12/25 14:30:05 31S0K630_225

Page 226: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To add oil, unscrew and remove theengine oil fill cap on top of the valvecover. Pour in the oil, and install theengine oil fill cap. Tighten it securely.Wait a few minutes and recheck theoil level. Do not fill above the uppermark; you could damage the engine.

Oil is major contributor to yourengine’s performance and longevity.Always use a premium-gradedetergent oil displaying the APICertification Seal. This seal indicatesthe oil is energy conserving, and thatit meets the American PetroleumInstitute’s latest requirements. It ishighly recommended that you useHonda Motor Oil in your vehicle foras long as you own it.

Make sure the API Certification Sealsays ‘‘For Gasoline Engines.’’

CONTINUED

Adding Oil Recommended Oil

Engine Oil

Maintenance 223

EENNGGIINNEE OOIILL FFIILLLL CCAAPPAAPPII CCEERRTTIIFFIICCAATTIIOONN SSEEAALL

00/12/25 14:30:15 31S0K630_226

Page 227: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

You may use a synthetic motor oil ifit meets the same requirementsgiven for a conventional motor oil: itdisplays the API Certification Seal,and it is the proper weight as shownon the chart. When using syntheticoil, you must follow the oil and filterchange intervals given in themaintenance schedule.

The numbers on the container's label

Select the oil for your vehicle according to this chart.

5W-20 oil is formulated for year-round protection of your Acura, toimprove cold weather starting, andto help your engine use less fuel.

If 5W-20 oil is not available, a 5W-30oil may be used. However, it shouldbe replaced with 5W-20 at the nextoil change.

Engine Oil

Maintenance

Synthetic Oil

224

AAmmbbiieenntt TTeemmppeerraattuurree

00/12/25 19:41:43 31S0K630_227

tell you the oil’s viscosity or weight.

Page 228: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

Always change the oil and filteraccording to the time and distance(miles/kilometers) recommenda-tions in the maintenance schedule.The oil and filter collect contami-nants that can damage your engine ifthey are not removed regularly.

Changing the oil and filter requiresspecial tools and access fromunderneath the car. The car shouldbe raised on a service station-typehydraulic lift for this service. Unlessyou have the knowledge and properequipment, you should have thismaintenance done by a skilledmechanic.

Run the engine until it reachesnormal operating temperature,then shut it off.

Your Acura does not need any oiladditives. Purchasing additives forthe engine or transmission will notincrease your car’s performance orlongevity. It only increases the costof operating your car.

1.

Engine Oil

Maintenance

Additives Changing the Oil and Filter

225

00/12/25 14:30:32 31S0K630_228

Page 229: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Open the hood and remove theengine oil fill cap. Remove the oildrain bolt and washer from thebottom of the engine. Drain the oilinto an appropriate container.

Remove the oil filter and let theremaining oil drain. A specialwrench (available from your Acuradealer) is required to remove thefilter.

Install a new oil filter according toinstructions that come with it.

Put a new washer on the drain bolt,then reinstall the drain bolt.Tighten it to:

4.

5.

3.2.

Engine Oil

Maintenance226

DDRRAAIINN BBOOLLTTWWAASSHHEERR OOIILL FFIILLTTEERR

29 lbf·ft (39 N·m , 4.0 kgf·m)

00/12/25 14:30:41 31S0K630_229

Page 230: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Replace the engine oil fill cap.Start the engine. The oil pressureindicator light should go out withinfive seconds. If it does not, turn offthe engine and reinspect yourwork.

Let the engine run for severalminutes and check the drain boltand oil filter for leaks.

Turn off the engine, let it sit forseveral minutes, then check the oillevel. If necessary, add oil to bringthe level to the upper mark on thedipstick.

Refill the engine with the recom-mended oil.Engine oil change capacity(including filter):

9.

8.

7.6.

Engine Oil

Maintenance 227

4.6 US qt (4.4 , 3.9 Imp qt)

Improper disposal of engine oil can beharmful to the environment. If youchange your own oil, please dispose ofthe used oil properly. Put it in a sealedcontainer and take it to a recyclingcenter. Do not discard it in a trash binor dump it on the ground.

00/12/25 14:30:49 31S0K630_230

Page 231: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If the coolant level in the reservetank is at or below the MIN line, addcoolant to bring it up to the MAX line.Inspect the cooling system for leaks.This coolant should always be amixture of 50 percent antifreeze and50 percent water. Never add straightantifreeze or plain water.

If the reserve tank is completelyempty, you should also check thecoolant level in the radiator.

Always use Honda All SeasonAntifreeze/Coolant Type 2. Thiscoolant is pre-mixed with 50 percentantifreeze and 50 percent water. Itdoes not require any additionalmixing. If it is not available, you mayuse another major-brand non-silicatecoolant as a temporary replacement.Make sure it is a high-quality coolantrecommended for aluminum engines.However, continued use of any non-Honda coolant can result incorrosion, causing the coolingsystem to malfunction or fail. Havethe cooling system flushed andrefilled with Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as possible.

Adding Engine Coolant

Cooling System

Maintenance228

RREESSEERRVVEE TTAANNKK

Removing the radiator capwhile the engine is hot cancause the coolant to spray out,seriously scalding you.

Always let the engine andradiator cool down beforeremoving the radiator cap.

00/12/25 14:30:57 31S0K630_231

Page 232: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

Turn the radiator cap counter-clockwise, without pressing downon it, until it stops. This relievesany pressure remaining in thecooling system.

Make sure the engine and radiatorare cool.

Remove the radiator cap bypushing down and turningcounterclockwise.

The coolant level should be up tothe base of the filler neck. Addcoolant if it is low.

Put the radiator cap back on.Tighten it fully.

3.

1.

2.

4.

5.

Cooling System

Maintenance 229

RRAADDIIAATTOORR CCAAPP

00/12/25 14:31:07 31S0K630_232

Page 233: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Pour coolant into the reserve tank.Fill it to halfway between the MAXand MIN marks. Put the cap backon the reserve tank.

Do not add any rust inhibitors orother additives to your car’s coolingsystem. They may not be compatiblewith the coolant or engine compo-nents.

The cooling system should becompletely drained and refilled withnew coolant according to the timeand distance recommendations inthe maintenance schedule. Only useHonda All Season Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2. Use of any non-Honda coolant or plain water canresult in corrosion and deposits inthe cooling system.

Draining the coolant requires accessto the underside of the car. Unlessyou have the tools and knowledge,you should have this maintenancedone by a skilled mechanic.

6.

Replacing Engine Coolant

Cooling System

Maintenance230

RREESSEERRVVEE TTAANNKK

00/12/25 14:31:15 31S0K630_233

Page 234: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

Remove the reserve tank from itsholder by pulling it straight up.Drain the coolant, then put thetank back in its holder.

When the coolant stops draining,tighten the drain plug at thebottom of the radiator.

Turn the ignition ON (II). Turnthe heater temperature controldial to maximum heat (climatecontrol to 90°F/32°C). Turn offthe ignition. Open the hood. Makesure the engine and radiator arecool to the touch.

Remove the radiator cap.

Loosen the drain plug on thebottom of the radiator. Thecoolant will drain through thesplash guard.

Install a rubber hose on the drainbolt at the rear of the enginecylinder block. Loosen the drainbolt.

3.1.

2.

4.

5.

6.

Cooling System

Maintenance 231

DDRRAAIINN PPLLUUGG RREESSEERRVVEE TTAANNKK CCAAPP

HHOOLLDDEERR

RREESSEERRVVEE TTAANNKK

DDRRAAIINN BBOOLLTT

00/12/25 14:31:26 31S0K630_234

Page 235: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Tighten the drain bolt at the rearof the engine cylinder blocksecurely.

Tightening torque:

Pour Honda All SeasonAntifreeze/Coolant Type 2 intothe radiator up to the base of thefiller neck. This coolant is amixture of 50 percent antifreezeand 50 percent water. Pre-mixingis not required.The cooling system capacity is:

Start the engine and let it run forabout 30 seconds. Then turn offthe engine. Pour coolant into the

radiator up to the base of the fillerneck.

Fill the reserve tank to the MAXmark. Install the reserve tank cap.

Install the radiator cap, andtighten it to the first stop.

7.

8.

9.

10.

11.

Cooling System

Maintenance232

FFiillll uupp ttoo hheerree

7 lbf·ft (9.8 N·m , 1.0 kgf·m)

1.48 US gal (5.6 , 1.23 Imp gal)

00/12/25 14:31:37 31S0K630_235

Page 236: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If necessary, fill the reserve tankto the MAX mark. Install thereserve tank cap.

Install the radiator cap, andtighten it fully.

Start the engine and hold it at1,500 rpm until the cooling fancomes on. Turn off the engine.Check the coolant level in theradiator and add coolant if needed.

Remove the radiator cap. Pourcoolant into the radiator up to thebase of the filler neck and into thereserve tank up to the MAX mark.

Start the engine and let it run untilthe radiator cooling fan comes onat least twice. Then stop theengine.

Check the level in the windshieldwasher reservoir at least monthlyduring normal usage. In bad weather,when you use the washers often,check the level every time you stopfor fuel.

The windshield washer reservoir islocated behind the passenger’s sideheadlight.

12.

13.

14.

15.

16.

CONTINUED

Maintenance

Cooling System, Windshield Washers

Windshield Washers

233

00/12/25 14:31:48 31S0K630_236

Page 237: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Check the fluid level with the engineat normal operating temperature.

Park the car on level ground. Shutoff the engine.

Remove the dipstick (yellow loop)from the transmission and wipe itwith a clean cloth.

Fill the reservoir with a good-qualitywindshield washer fluid. Thisincreases the cleaning capability andprevents freezing in cold weather.

When you refill the reservoir, cleanthe edges of the windshield wiperblades with windshield washer fluidon a clean cloth. This will help tocondition the blade edges.

Check the reservoir’s fluid level byremoving the cap and looking at thelevel gauge attached to the cap.

The low washer level indicator willlight when the level is low (see page

).

1.

2.63

Maintenance

Windshield Washers, Automatic Transmission Fluid

Automatic Transmission Fluid

Canadian Models

234

DDIIPPSSTTIICCKK

Do not use engine antif reeze or avinegar/water solution in thewindshield washer reservoir.

Antif reeze can damage your car’s paint,while a vinegar/water solution candamage the windshield washer pump.

Use only commercially-availablewindshield washer f luid.

00/12/25 14:32:00 31S0K630_237

Page 238: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Insert the dipstick all the way intothe transmission securely asshown in the illustration.

Remove the dipstick and checkthe fluid level. It should bebetween the upper and lowermarks.

If the level is below the lowermark, remove the fill plug and addfluid to bring it to the upper mark.

Insert the dipstick all the way backinto the transmission securely asshown in the illustration.

The transmission should be drainedand refilled with new fluid accordingto the time and distance recommen-dations in the maintenance schedule.

If you are not sure how to add fluid,contact your Acura dealer.

Always use Honda ATF-Z1(Automatic Transmission Fluid). Ifit is not available, you may use aDEXRON III automatictransmission fluid as a temporaryreplacement. However, continueduse can affect shift quality. Havethe transmission flushed andrefilled with Honda ATF-Z1 assoon as it is convenient.

To thoroughly flush thetransmission, the technicianshould drain and refill it withHonda ATF-Z1, then drive thevehicle a short distance. Do thisthree times. Then drain and refillthe transmission a final time.

3.

5. 6.

4.

Maintenance

Automatic Transmission Fluid

235

UUPPPPEERR MMAARRKK

LLOOWWEERR MMAARRKK

00/12/25 14:32:11 31S0K630_238

Page 239: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The fluid level should be betweenthe MIN and MAX marks on the sideof the reservoir. If the level is at orbelow the MIN mark, your brakesystem needs attention. Have thebrake system inspected for leaks orworn brake pads.

Always use Honda Heavy DutyBrake Fluid DOT 3. If it is notavailable, you should use only DOT 3or DOT 4 fluid, from a sealedcontainer, as a temporaryreplacement. However, the use ofany non-Honda brake fluid can causecorrosion and decrease the life of thesystem. Have the brake systemflushed and refilled with HondaHeavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3 assoon as possible.

Check the fluid level in the brakefluid reservoir monthly.

The brake fluid should be replacedaccording to the time recommenda-tion in the maintenance schedule.

Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is notcompatible with your car’s brakingsystem and can cause extensivedamage.

Brake System

Maintenance

Brake Fluid

236

MMAAXX

MMIINN

00/12/25 14:32:20 31S0K630_239

Page 240: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Check the level when the engine iscold. Look at the side of thereservoir. The fluid should bebetween the UPPER LEVEL andLOWER LEVEL. If it is below theLOWER LEVEL, add power steeringfluid to the UPPER LEVEL.

Always use Honda Power SteeringFluid. If it is not available, you mayuse another power steering fluid asan emergency replacement.However, continued use can causeincreased wear and poor steering incold weather. Have the powersteering system flushed and refilledwith Honda PSF as soon as possible.

A low power steering fluid level canindicate a leak in the system. Checkthe fluid level frequently and havethe system inspected as soon aspossible. Clean the hood latch assembly with a

mild cleaner, then lubricate it with amultipurpose grease. Lubricate allthe moving parts (as shown),including the pivot. Follow the timeand distance recommendations inthe Maintenance Schedule. If youare not sure how to clean and greasethe latch, contact your Acura dealer.

Maintenance

Power Steering Hood Latch

Power Steering, Hood Latch

237

MMAAXX

MMIINN

LLAATTCCHHAASSSSEEMMBBLLYY

Turning the steering wheel to f ull lef tor right lock and holding it there candamage the power steering pump.

00/12/25 14:32:31 31S0K630_240

Page 241: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The air cleaner element should becleaned or replaced according to thetime and distance recommendationsin the maintenance schedule.

Loosen the two bolts with a Phillips-head screwdriver. Remove the aircleaner housing cover by lifting andpivoting it out of the loops.

Loosen the four bolts by using aPhillips-head screwdriver andremove the air cleaner housingcover.

Clean the air cleaner element byblowing compressed air through it inthe opposite direction to normal airflow. If you do not have access tocompressed air (such as a servicestation), ask your Acura dealer to dothis service.

Follow the replacement procedurefor removal and reinstallation.

The air cleaner element is inside theair cleaner housing on the driver’sside of the engine compartment.To replace it:

1.

On Premium model

On Premium model On Type S

Maintenance

Air Cleaner Element

Cleaning (Severe Conditions)

Replacement

238

BBOOLLTTSS

LLOOOOPP

BBOOLLTTSS

00/12/25 14:32:42 31S0K630_241

Page 242: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Carefully clean the inside of theair cleaner housing with a damprag.

Align the tabs on the battery sideand reinstall the air cleanerhousing cover, then tighten thetwo bolts.

Remove the old air cleanerelement.

Place the new air cleaner elementin the air cleaner housing.

Reinstall the air cleaner housingcover, tighten the four bolts.

2. 3.

4.

5. On Premium model

On Type S

Air Cleaner Element

Maintenance 239

TTyyppee SSAAIIRR CCLLEEAANNEERREELLEEMMEENNTT

AAIIRR CCLLEEAANNEERREELLEEMMEENNTTPPrreemmiiuumm mmooddeell

00/12/25 14:32:51 31S0K630_242

Page 243: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Disconnect the wire connectorfrom the ignition coil by pushingon the lock tab and pulling on theconnector. Pull on the plasticconnector, not the wires.

Loosen the two holding clips byturning the heads one-quarter turncounterclockwise with a flat-tippedscrewdriver. Remove the cover onthe front cylinder bank by pullingit straight up.

Clean up any dirt and oil that havecollected around the ignition coils.

The spark plugs in your car are aspecial platinum-tipped design forlonger life. The spark plugs shouldbe replaced according to the timeand distance recommendations inthe maintenance schedule.

1.

2.

3.

Replacement

Spark Plugs

Maintenance240

HHOOLLDDIINNGGCCLLIIPP

LLOOCCKK TTAABB

00/12/25 14:33:01 31S0K630_243

Page 244: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Put the new spark plug into thesocket; then screw it into the hole.Screw it in by hand so you do notcrossthread it.

Torque the spark plug. (If you donot have a torque wrench, tightenthe spark plug two-thirds of a turnafter it contacts the cylinder head.)Tightening torque:

Use a wrench to remove thehexagon socket head cap boltholding the ignition coil. Removethe ignition coil by pulling itstraight out.

Remove the spark plug witha five-eighths inch (16 mm) sparkplug socket.

4.

5.

6. 7.

CONTINUED

Spark Plugs

Maintenance 241

HHEEXXAAGGOONN SSOOCCKKEETT HHEEAADD CCAAPP BBOOLLTT

13 lbf·ft (18 N·m , 1.8 kgf·m)

00/12/25 14:33:11 31S0K630_244

Page 245: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

+-

+-

Push the wire connector onto theignition coil. Make sure it locks inplace.

Install the ignition coil. Reinstallthe hexagon socket head cap bolt.

Repeat this procedure for theother five spark plugs.

Reinstall the cover on the frontcylinder bank while putting itsmounting clip in the hole on thepassenger’s side. Secure the coverby turning the heads of the twoholding clips one-quarter turnclockwise with a flat-tippedscrewdriver.

Spark Plug Gap:

Spark Plug Gap:

NGK:DENSO:

8.

11.

10.

9.NGK:DENSO:

Specifications:

Spark Plugs

Maintenance

Type S

Premium model

242

0.04 in (1.1 mm)

PKJ20CR-M11PZFR6E-11

0.04 in (1.1 mm)

PKJ16CR-L11PZFR5F-11

00.1 mm

00.1 mm

Tighten the spark plugs caref ully. Aspark plug that is too loose canoverheat and damage the engine.Overtightening can cause damage tothe threads in the cylinder head.

00/12/25 14:33:22 31S0K630_245

Page 246: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Check the battery terminals forcorrosion (a white or yellowishpowder). To remove it, cover theterminals with a solution of bakingsoda and water. It will bubble up andturn brown. When this stops, wash itoff with plain water. Dry off thebattery with a cloth or paper towel.Coat the terminals with grease tohelp prevent future corrosion.

Check the condition of your car’sbattery monthly. You should checkthe color of the test indicator window,and for corrosion on the terminals.

Remove the battery cover.

Check the battery condition bylooking at the test indicator windowon the battery.The label on the battery explains thetest indicator’s colors.

Battery posts,terminals and related accessoriescontain lead and lead compounds.

CONTINUED

WARNING:

Wash hands after handling.

Battery

Maintenance 243

TTEESSTT IINNDDIICCAATTOORR WWIINNDDOOWW

00/12/25 14:33:31 31S0K630_246

Page 247: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If the terminals are severely cor-roded, clean them with baking sodaand water. Then use a wrench toloosen and remove the cables fromthe terminals. Always disconnect thenegative ( ) cable first and recon-nect it last. Clean the battery termi-nals with a terminal cleaning tool orwire brush. Reconnect and tightenthe cables, then coat the terminalswith grease.

If you need to connect the battery toa charger, disconnect both cables toprevent damage to the car’selectrical system.

Battery

Maintenance244

The battery gives off explosivehydrogen gas during normaloperation.

A spark or flame can cause thebattery to explode with enoughforce to kill or seriously hurt you.

Wear protective clothing and aface shield, or have a skilledmechanic do the batterymaintenance.

00/12/25 14:33:37 31S0K630_247

Page 248: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If your car’s battery is disconnectedor goes dead, the audio system willdisable itself. The next time you turnon the radio you will see ‘‘Code’’ inthe frequency display. Use thePreset buttons to enter the five-digitcode (see page ).

If your car’s battery is disconnectedor goes dead, all stored drivingpositions will be lost. To store thedriving positions again, see thestoring procedure on page .

The Navigation System will alsodisable itself. The next time you turnon the ignition switch, the systemwill require you to enter a PINbefore it can be used. Refer to theNavigation System Owner’s Manual.

151

96

Cars with Navigation System

Battery

Maintenance 245

Charging the battery with the cablesconnected can seriously damage yourcar’s electronic controls. Detach thebattery cables bef ore connecting thebattery to a charger.

00/12/25 14:33:43 31S0K630_248

Page 249: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Check the condition of the wiperblades at least every six months.Look for signs of cracking in therubber, or areas that are gettinghard. Replace the blades if you findthese signs, or they leave streaksand unwiped areas when used.

Disconnect the blade assemblyfrom the wiper arm by pushing inthe lock tab. Hold it in while youpush the blade assembly towardthe base of the arm.

To replace the blade:

Raise the wiper arm off thewindshield.

Turn the ignition ON (II), switchthe wipers to INT or (lowposition), then turn the ignitionOFF when the wiper arm isapproximately midway in its travel.

2.

1.

3.

Wiper Blades

Maintenance246

WWIIPPEERR AARRMMSS

LLOOCCKK TTAABB

00/12/25 14:33:52 31S0K630_249

Page 250: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Remove the blade from its holderby grasping the tabbed end of theblade. Pull firmly until the tabscome out of the holder.

Examine the new wiper blades. Ifthey have no plastic or metal rein-forcement along the back edge,remove the metal reinforcementstrips from the old wiper blade andinstall them in the slots along theedge of the new blade.

Slide the new wiper blade into theholder until the tabs lock.

Lower the wiper arm down againstthe windshield.

Slide the wiper blade assemblyonto the wiper arm. Make sure itlocks in place.

Turn the ignition switch ON (II)and return the windshield wipersto their park position.

4. 5.

6.

7.

8.

9.

Wiper Blades

Maintenance 247

RREEIINNFFOORRCCEEMMEENNTT

BBLLAADDEE BBLLAADDEE

00/12/25 14:34:02 31S0K630_250

Page 251: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Run the air conditioning at least oncea week during the cold weathermonths. Run it for at least tenminutes while you are driving at asteady speed with the engine atnormal operating temperature. Thiscirculates the lubricating oil con-tained in the refrigerant.

If the air conditioning does not get ascold as before, have your dealercheck the system. Recharge thesystem with Refrigerant HFC-134a(R-134a). (See Specifications on page

.)

Your car’s air conditioning is a sealedsystem. Any major maintenance,such as recharging, should be doneby a qualified mechanic. You can doa couple of things to make sure theair conditioning works efficiently.

Periodically check the engine’sradiator and air conditioningcondenser for leaves, insects, anddirt stuck to the front surface. Theseblock the air flow and reduce coolingefficiency. Use a light spray from ahose or a soft brush to remove them.

308

Air Conditioning System

Maintenance248

AAIIRR CCOONNDDIITTIIOONNIINNGG CCOONNDDEENNSSEERR

Whenever you have the air conditioningsystem serviced, make sure the servicef acility uses a ref rigerant recyclingsystem. This system captures theref rigerant f or reuse. Releasingref rigerant into the atmosphere candamage the environment.

The condenser and radiator f ins bendeasily. Only use a low-pressure sprayor sof t-bristle brush to clean them.

00/12/25 14:34:10 31S0K630_251

Page 252: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

- -

This filter should be replaced every30,000 miles (48,000 km) under nor-mal conditions. It should be replacedevery 15,000 miles (24,000 km) if youdrive primarily in urban areas thathave high concentrations of soot inthe air from industry and diesel-pow-ered vehicles. Replace it more oftenif air flow from the climate controlsystem becomes less than usual.Have the air conditioning filter re-placed by your Acura dealer.

The air conditioning filter removespollen and dust that is brought infrom the outside through the climatecontrol system.

Check the tension of the powersteering belt by pushing on it withyour thumb midway between thepulleys.

Check the condition of the two drivebelts (power steering belt andalternator belt). Examine the edgesof each belt for cracks or fraying.

If you see signs of wear or looseness,have your dealer adjust or replacethe belts.

Power steering belt:

The belt should have the following‘‘play’’ or deflection.

Drive BeltsAir Conditioning Filter

Air Conditioning Filter, Drive Belts

Maintenance 249

PPOOWWEERR SSTTEEEERRIINNGG BBEELLTT

AALLTTEERRNNAATTOORR BBEELLTT

0.51 0.65 in (13.0 16.5 mm)

00/12/25 14:34:22 31S0K630_252

Page 253: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

- -

The timing belt should normally bereplaced at the intervals shown inthe maintenance schedule.

Replace this belt at 60,000 miles (U.S.)or 100,000 km (Canada) if youregularly drive your car in one ormore of these conditions:

In very high temperatures(over 110°F, 43°C).In very low temperatures(under 20°F, 29°C).

To safely operate your car, your tiresmust be the proper type and size, ingood condition with adequate tread,and correctly inflated. The followingpages give more detailed informationon how and when to check airpressure, how to inspect your tiresfor damage and wear, and what to dowhen your tires need to be replaced.

Timing Belt Tires

Timing Belt, Tires

Maintenance250

Using tires that are excessivelyworn or improperly inflated cancause a crash in which you canbe seriously hurt or killed.

Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regarding tireinflation and maintenance.

00/12/25 14:34:31 31S0K630_253

Page 254: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

We recommend that you visuallycheck your tires every day. If youthink a tire might be low, check itimmediately with a tire gauge.

Use a gauge to measure the airpressure at least once a month. Eventires that are in good condition maylose one to two psi (10 to 20 kPa, 0.1to 0.2 kgf/cm ) per month.Remember to check the spare tire atthe same time you check all theother tires.

Keeping the tires properly inflatedprovides the best combination ofhandling, tread life and ridingcomfort. Underinflated tires wearunevenly, adversely affect handlingand fuel economy, and are morelikely to fail from being overheated.Overinflated tires can make your carride more harshly, are more prone todamage from road hazards, and wearunevenly.

If you check the pressure when thetires are hot (the car has been drivenseveral miles), you will see readings4 to 6 psi (30 to 40 kPa, 0.3 to 0.4kgf/cm ) higher than the coldreading. This is normal. Do not letair out to match the specified coldpressure. The tire will beunderinflated.

You should get your own tirepressure gauge and use it wheneveryou check your tire pressures. Thiswill make it easier for you to tell if apressure loss is due to a tire problemand not due to a variation betweengauges.

Check the pressure in the tires whenthey are cold. This means the carhas been parked for at least threehours. If you have to drive the carbefore checking the tire pressure,the tires can still be considered‘‘cold’’ if you drive less than 1 mile(1.6 km).

CONTINUED

Inflation

Tires

Maintenance 251

00/12/25 14:34:41 31S0K630_254

Page 255: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The following chart shows therecommended cold tire pressures formost normal driving conditions andspeeds. Tire pressures for highspeed driving are the same as fornormal driving.

Every time you check inflation, youshould also examine the tires fordamage, foreign objects, and wear.

You should look for:

Bumps or bulges in the tread orside of the tire. Replace the tire ifyou find either of these conditions.

Cuts, splits, or cracks in the sideof the tire. Replace the tire if youcan see fabric or cord.

Excessive tread wear.

The compact spare tire pressure is:

These pressures are also given onthe tire information label on thedriver’s doorjamb.

Tubeless tires have some ability toself-seal if they are punctured.However, because leakage is oftenvery slow, you should look closelyfor punctures if a tire starts losingpressure.

Cold Tire Pressurefor Normal Driving

Tire Size

Tire Size Cold Tire Pressurefor Normal Driving

Type S

Premium modelRecommended Tire Pressures forNormal Driving

Inspection

Tires

Maintenance252

P205/60R16 91V 32 psi (220 kPa ,2.2 kgf/cm )

P215/50R17 93V 32 psi (220 kPa ,2.2 kgf/cm )

60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )

00/12/25 14:34:57 31S0K630_255

Page 256: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Your car’s tires have wear indicatorsmolded into the tread. When thetread wears down to that point, youwill see a 1/2 inch (12.7 mm) wideband running across the tread. Thisshows there is less than 1/16 inch(1.6 mm) of tread left on the tire. Atire that is this worn gives very littletraction on wet roads. You shouldreplace the tire if you can see thetread wear indicator in three or moreplaces around the tire.

In addition to proper inflation,correct wheel alignment helps todecrease tire wear. If you find a tireis worn unevenly, have your dealercheck the wheel alignment.

The tires were properly balanced bythe factory. They may need to berebalanced at some time before theyare worn out. Have your dealercheck the tires if you feel a consis-tent vibration while driving. A tireshould always be rebalanced if it isremoved from the wheel for repair.

Make sure the installer balances thewheels when you have new tiresinstalled. This increases ridingcomfort and tire life. Your car’soriginal tires were dynamic or ‘‘spin’’balanced at the factory. For bestresults, have the installer perform adynamic balance.

Maintenance

Tires

Maintenance 253

IINNDDIICCAATTOORR LLOOCCAATTIIOONN MMAARRKKSS

TTRREEAADD WWEEAARR IINNDDIICCAATTOORRSS Improper wheel weights can damageyour car’s aluminum wheels. Use onlyGenuine Acura wheel weights f orbalancing.

00/12/25 14:35:15 31S0K630_256

Page 257: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To help increase tire life anddistribute wear more evenly, youshould have the tires rotated every7,500 miles (12,000 km). Move thetires to the positions shown in thechart each time they are rotated.

When shopping for replacementtires, you may find that some tiresare ‘‘directional.’’ This means theyare designed to rotate only in onedirection. If you use directional tires,they should be rotated only front-to-back.

The tires that came with your carwere selected to match the perform-ance capabilities of the car whileproviding the best combination ofhandling, ride comfort, and long life.You should replace them with radialtires of the same size, load range,speed rating, and maximum cold tirepressure rating (as shown on thetire’s sidewall). Mixing radial andbias-ply tires on your car can reduceits braking ability, traction, andsteering accuracy.

Tire Rotation Replacing Tires and Wheels

Tires

Maintenance254

((FFoorr NNoonn--ddiirreeccttiioonnaallTTiirreess aanndd WWhheeeellss))

((FFoorr DDiirreeccttiioonnaallTTiirreess aanndd WWhheeeellss))

FFrroonnttFFrroonntt

00/12/25 14:35:23 31S0K630_257

Page 258: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Wheel:

It is best to replace all four tires atthe same time. If that is not possibleor necessary, then replace the twofront tires or the two rear tires as apair. Replacing just one tire canseriously affect your car’s handling.

If you ever need to replace a wheel,make sure you use an identical stylealuminum alloy wheel that originallycame on your Acura. Replacementwheels are available at your Acuradealer.

The ABS and VSA system work bycomparing the speed of the wheels.When replacing tires, use the samesize originally supplied with the car.Tire size and construction can affectwheel speed and may cause thesystem to work inconsistently.

Tire:

See page for information aboutDOT Tire Quality Grading.

310

Type S

Premium model

Type S

Premium model

Wheels and Tires

Tires

Maintenance 255

16 x 6 1/2 JJ

P205/60R16 91V

P215/50R17 93V

17 x 6 1/2 JJ

Installing improper tires on yourcar can affect handling andstability. This can cause a crashin which you can be seriouslyhurt or killed.

Always use the size and type oftires recommended in thisowner’s manual.

00/12/25 14:35:34 31S0K630_258

Page 259: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

+Tires that are marked ‘‘M S’’ or‘‘All Season’’ on the sidewall have anall-weather tread design. Theyshould be suitable for most winterdriving conditions. Tires withoutthese markings are designed foroptimum traction in dry conditions.They may not provide adequateperformance in winter driving.For the best performance in snowyor icy conditions, you should installsnow tires or tire chains. They maybe required by local laws undercertain conditions.

If you mount snow tires on yourAcura, make sure they are radialtires of the same size and load rangeas the original tires. Mount snowtires on all four wheels to balanceyour car’s handling in all weatherconditions. Keep in mind the tractionprovided by snow tires on dry roadsmay not be as high as your car’s

original equipment tires. You shoulddrive cautiously even when the roadsare clear. Check with the tire dealerfor maximum speed recommen-dations.

Because your Acura has limited tireclearance, mount only SAE Class ‘‘S’’cable-type traction devices on thefront tires. Use traction devices onlywhen required by driving conditionsor local laws. Make sure they are thecorrect size for your tires.

Metal link-type ‘‘chains’’ should notbe used. No matter how tight theyseem to be installed, they can comeinto contact with the body andsuspension, causing serious damage.

When installing cables, follow themanufacturer’s instructions andmount them as tightly as you can.Drive slowly with them installed. If

you hear them coming in contactwith the body or chassis, stop andinvestigate. Make sure the cables areinstalled tightly, and that they arenot contacting the brake lines orsuspension.Remove them as soon as you begindriving on cleared roads.

Do not install any types of chainsor cable-type traction devices onyour vehicle.

Type S

Premium model only

Winter Driving

Snow Tires

Traction Devices

Tires

Maintenance256

Traction devices that are the wrongsize or improperly installed candamage your car’s brake lines,suspension, body, and wheels. Stopdriving if they are hitting any part ofthe car.

00/12/25 14:35:47 31S0K630_259

Page 260: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Check the operation of your car’sexterior lights at least once a month.A burned out bulb can create anunsafe condition by reducing yourcar’s visibility and the ability tosignal your intentions to otherdrivers.

CONTINUED

Lights

Maintenance 257

TURN SIGNAL/SIDE MARKER LIGHT/PARKING LIGHT

FOG LIGHT

HIGH BEAM HEADLIGHT

LOW BEAM HEADLIGHT

00/12/25 14:35:53 31S0K630_260

Page 261: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Check the following:

Headlights (low and high beam)Fog lightsParking lightsTaillightsBrake lightsTurn signalsBack-up lightsHazard light functionLicense plate lightSide marker lightsHigh-mount brake lightDaytime running lights (Canadianmodels)

If you find any bulbs are burned out,replace them as soon as possible.Refer to the chart on page todetermine what type of replacementbulb is needed.

309

Lights

Maintenance258

HHIIGGHH--MMOOUUNNTT BBRRAAKKEE LLIIGGHHTT

TTUURRNN SSIIGGNNAALLLLIIGGHHTT

BBAACCKK--UUPP LLIIGGHHTT

LLIICCEENNSSEE PPLLAATTEE LLIIGGHHTT SSTTOOPP//TTAAIILLLLIIGGHHTTSS

00/12/25 14:36:01 31S0K630_261

Page 262: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The low beam headlight bulbs are atype of high voltage discharge tube.High voltage can remain in thecircuit even with the light switch offand the key removed. Because ofthis, you should not attempt toexamine or change a low beamheadlight bulb yourself. If a lowbeam headlight bulb fails, take thecar to your dealer to have it replaced.

Halogen bulbs are used for the highbeam headlight bulbs. Whenreplacing a high beam headlight bulb,handle it by its base and protect theglass from contact with your skin orhard objects. If you touch the glass,clean it with denatured alcohol and aclean cloth.

The headlights were properly aimedwhen your car was new. If youregularly carry heavy items in thetrunk or pull a trailer, readjustmentmay be required. Adjustment of theheadlights should be performed byan Acura technician or otherqualified mechanic.

CONTINUED

Replacing a Headlight BulbHeadlight Aiming

Lights

Maintenance 259

Halogen headlight bulbs get very hotwhen lit. Oil, perspiration, or a scratchon the glass can cause the bulb tooverheat and shatter.

00/12/25 14:36:10 31S0K630_262

Page 263: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Insert the new bulb into the holeand turn it one-quarter turn clock-wise to lock it in place.

Push the electrical connector backonto the bulb. Make sure it is onall the way.

Turn on the headlights to test thenew bulb.

Remove the bulb by turning itapproximately one-quarter turncounterclockwise.

Open the hood.

Reinstall the radiator reserve tank.If you need to change a bulb onthe driver’s side, remove theradiator reserve tank.

Remove the electrical connectorfrom the bulb by squeezing theconnector to unlock the tab, thenslide the connector off the bulb.

The front side marker/turn signallight bulb and parking light bulb usethe same bulb.

If you are changing the bulb onthe driver’s side, start the engine,turn the steering wheel all the wayto the right, and turn off theengine. If you are changing thebulb on the passenger’s side, turnthe steering wheel to the left.

1.

3.

4.

7.

6.

5.

1.

2.

Replacing Front Turn Signal andSide Marker Light Bulbs

Lights

Maintenance260

BBUULLBB

TTAABB

00/12/25 14:36:24 31S0K630_263

Page 264: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Remove the burned out bulb fromthe socket by pushing it in andturning counterclockwise until itunlocks.

Install the new bulb in the socket.Turn it clockwise to lock it in place.

Insert the socket back into theheadlight assembly. Turn itclockwise to lock it in place.

Test the lights to make sure thenew bulb is working.Remove the socket from the

headlight assembly by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.

Pull the inner fender cover awayfrom the fender and bumper.

Put the inner fender cover in place.Install the three holding clips.Lock each clip in place by pushingon the center.

Use a flat-tipped screwdriver toremove the three holding clipsfrom the inner fender.

4.

5.

6.

7.

8.

9.

2.

3.

Lights

Maintenance 261

HHOOLLDDIINNGG CCLLIIPP

00/12/25 14:36:35 31S0K630_264

Page 265: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Insert the new bulb into the holeand turn it one-quarter turn clock-wise to lock it in place.

Push the electrical connector ontothe new bulb. Turn on the frontfog lights to test the new bulb.

Put the light assembly into thebumper. Tighten the mountingbolt.

Remove the light assembly fromthe bumper.

Use a wrench to loosen the lightassembly’s mounting bolt.

Your car uses halogen fog lightbulbs. See page for informationon replacing a halogen bulb.

Remove the bulb by turning itapproximately one-quarter turncounterclockwise.

Remove the electrical connectorfrom the bulb by squeezing theconnector to unlock the tab, thenslide the connector off the bulb.

5.

6.

7.

1.

2.

3.

4.

309

Lights

Maintenance

Replacing a Fog Light Bulb

262

MMOOUUNNTTIINNGG BBOOLLTTBBUULLBB CCOONNNNEECCTTOORR

00/12/25 14:36:47 31S0K630_265

Page 266: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Determine which of the four bulbsis burned out: stop/taillights, turnsignal light, or back-up light.

Remove the socket by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.

Open the trunk.

Remove the fastener on the edgeof the trunk opening by turning itcounterclockwise with a coin.Unscrew the cargo net mountingbutton. Pull the lining back.

Screw the cargo net mountingbutton back into the hole.

Put the fastener in the hole on theside of the trunk lining and pushon the center until it locks (thecenter is flush with the head).

Reinstall the trunk lining. Makesure it is installed under the edgeof the trunk seal.

Test the lights to make sure thenew bulb is working.

Reinstall the socket into the lightassembly by turning it clockwiseuntil it locks.

To remove the turn signal bulbpush it in slightly and turn itcounterclockwise. To remove thestop/taillight or back-up light, pullthe bulb straight out of its socket.

Install the new bulb into thesocket.

3.

2.

4.

5.

6.

7.

8.

9.1.

10.

Lights

Maintenance

Replacing Rear Bulbs

263

FFAASSTTEENNEERR

CCAARRGGOO NNEETT MMOOUUNNTTIINNGGBBUUTTTTOONN

00/12/25 14:37:02 31S0K630_266

Page 267: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Open the trunk and remove thesocket from the light assembly byturning it one-quarter turn counter-clockwise.

Remove the burned-out bulb bypulling it straight out of the socket.

Install the new bulb and reinstallthe socket. Make sure the newbulb is working.

Use a small Phillips-headscrewdriver to remove the twoscrews. Remove the lens from thelicense plate assembly.

Remove the bulb by pulling itstraight out. Push the new bulbinto the socket.

Put the lens back in place andtighten the two screws securely.

1.

2.

3.

1.

2.

3.Replacing a High-mount BrakeLight Bulb

Replacing a Rear License PlateBulb

Lights

Maintenance264

00/12/25 14:37:13 31S0K630_267

Page 268: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

The ceiling light, door light andvanity mirror light come apart thesame way, but they do not use thesame type of bulb.

Remove the bulb by pulling itstraight out of its metal tabs.

Push the new bulb into the metaltabs. Snap the lens back in place.

Remove the lens by carefullyprying on the edge of the lens witha fingernail file or a small flat-tipscrewdriver. Do not pry on theedge of the housing around thelens.

Door light:Pry on the top middle of the lens.

Ceiling light:Pry on the front edge of the lensnear both sides.

Spotlights:Pry on the front edge in front ofboth spotlights.

1.

2.

3.

Maintenance

Lights

Replacing Bulbs in the InteriorLights

265

CCEEIILLIINNGG LLIIGGHHTT SSPPOOTTLLIIGGHHTTSS

00/12/25 14:37:25 31S0K630_268

Page 269: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Open the trunk. Pull down thetrunk light cover.

Remove the bulb by pulling itstraight out of its metal tabs.

Push the new bulb into the metaltabs.

Push the cover back in place.

1.

2.

3.

4.

Lights

Maintenance

Replacing the Trunk Light Bulb

266

DDOOOORR LLIIGGHHTT

TTRRUUNNKK LLIIGGHHTT

VVAANNIITTYY MMIIRRRROORR LLIIGGHHTT

00/12/25 14:37:36 31S0K630_269

Page 270: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Block the rear wheels.

Fill the fuel tank.

Change the engine oil and filter(see page ).

Wash and dry the exteriorcompletely.

Clean the interior. Make sure thecarpeting, floor mats, etc. arecompletely dry.

If you need to park your car for anextended period (more than onemonth), there are several things youshould do to prepare it for storage.Proper preparation helps preventdeterioration and makes it easier toget your car back on the road. Ifpossible, store your car indoors.

Leave the parking brake off. Putthe transmission in Park.

If the car is to be stored for alonger period, it should besupported on jackstands so thetires are off the ground.

Cover the car with a ‘‘breathable’’cover, one made from a porousmaterial such as cotton.Nonporous materials, such asplastic sheeting, trap moisture,which can damage the paint.

If possible, run the engine for awhile periodically (preferably oncea month).

Leave one window open slightly (ifthe car is being stored indoors).

Disconnect the battery.

Support the front wiper bladearms with a folded towel or rag sothey do not touch the windshield.

To minimize sticking, apply asilicone spray lubricant to all doorand trunk seals. Also, apply avehicle body wax to the paintedsurfaces that mate with the doorand trunk seals.

If you store your car for 12 monthsor longer, have your Acura dealerperform the inspections called for inthe 24 months/30,000 miles (48,000km) maintenance schedule (NormalConditions) as soon as you take itout of storage (see page ). Thereplacements called for in themaintenance schedule are notneeded unless the car has actuallyreached that time or mileage.

214

225

Storing Your Car

Maintenance 267

00/12/25 14:37:50 31S0K630_270

Page 271: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

268

Page 272: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Regular cleaning and polishing ofyour Acura helps to keep it ‘‘new’’looking. This section gives you hintson how to clean your car andpreserve its appearance: the paint,brightwork, wheels and interior. Alsoincluded are several things you cando to help prevent corrosion.

.................................Exterior Care . 270.....................................Washing . 270

.......................................Waxing . 271....................Aluminum Wheels . 271

..........................Paint Touch-up . 271..................................Interior Care . 272...................................Carpeting . 272.................................Floor Mats . 272

.........................................Fabric . 273...........................................Vinyl . 273

.......................................Leather . 273...................................Seat Belts . 273....................................Windows . 274

..........................Air Fresheners . 274....................Corrosion Protection . 275

.................................Body Repairs . 276

Appearance Care

Appearance Care 269

00/12/25 14:37:58 31S0K630_272

Page 273: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

When you have washed and rinsedthe whole exterior, dry it with achamois or soft towel. Letting itair-dry will cause dulling and waterspots.

Fill a bucket with cool water. Mixin a mild detergent, such asdishwashing liquid or a productmade especially for car washing.

Only use the solvents and cleanersrecommended in this Owner’sManual.

Frequent washing helps preserveyour car’s beauty. Dirt and grit canscratch the paint, while tree sap andbird droppings can permanently ruinthe finish.

Wash your car in a shady area, not indirect sunlight. If the car is parked inthe sun, move it into the shade andlet the exterior cool down before youstart.

Rinse the car thoroughly with coolwater to remove loose dirt.

As you dry the car, inspect it forchips and scratches that could allowcorrosion to start. Repair them withtouch-up paint (see page ).

Wash the car using the water anddetergent solution and a soft-bristle brush, sponge, or soft cloth.Start at the top and work your waydown. Rinse frequently.

Check the body for road tar, treesap, etc. Remove these stains withtar remover or turpentine. Rinse itoff immediately so it does notharm the finish. Remember to re-wax these areas, even if the rest ofthe car does not need waxing.

271

Exterior Care

Appearance Care

Washing

270

Chemical solvents and strong cleanerscan damage the paint, metal, andplastic on your car.

00/12/25 14:38:10 31S0K630_273

Page 274: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Always wash and dry the whole carbefore waxing it. You should waxyour car, including the metal trim,whenever water sits on the surfacein large patches. It should form intobeads or droplets after waxing.

You should use a quality liquid orpaste wax. Apply it according to theinstructions on the container. Ingeneral, there are two types ofproducts:

Waxes A wax coats the finish andprotects it from damage by exposureto sunlight, air pollution, etc. Youshould use a wax on your Acurawhen it is new.

Polishes Polishes and cleaner/waxes can restore the shine to paintthat has oxidized and lost some of itsshine. They normally contain mildabrasives and solvents that removethe top layer of the finish. You

should use a polish on your Acura ifthe finish does not have its originalshine after using a wax.

Cleaning tar, insects, etc. withremovers also takes off the wax.Remember to re-wax those areas,even if the rest of the car does notneed waxing.

Clean your Acura’s aluminum alloywheels as you do the rest of theexterior. Wash them with the samesolution, and rinse them thoroughly.

The wheels have a protective clear-coat that keeps the aluminum fromcorroding and tarnishing. Usingharsh chemicals, including somecommercial wheel cleaners, or stiffbrushes can damage this clear-coat.Only use a mild detergent and softbrush or sponge to clean the wheels.

Your dealer has touch-up paint tomatch your car’s color. The colorcode is printed on a sticker on thedriver’s doorjamb. Take this code toyour dealer so you are sure to getthe correct color.

Inspect your car frequently for chipsor scratches in the paint. Repairthem right away to prevent corrosionof the metal underneath. Use thetouch-up paint only on small chipsand scratches. More extensive paintdamage should be repaired by aprofessional.

Exterior Care

Appearance Care

Waxing Paint Touch-up

Aluminum Wheels

271

00/12/25 14:38:22 31S0K630_274

Page 275: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Vacuum the carpeting frequently toremove dirt. Ground-in dirt will makethe carpet wear out faster.Periodically shampoo the carpet tokeep it looking new. Use one of thefoam-type carpet cleaners on themarket. Follow the instructions thatcome with the cleaner, applying itwith a sponge or soft brush. Keepthe carpeting as dry as possible bynot adding water to the foam.

The Genuine Acura driver’s floormat that came with your car wasdesigned to be hooked over the floormat anchor. This keeps the floor matfrom sliding forward and possiblyinterfering with the pedals.

If you remove the floor mat, makesure to re-anchor it when you put itback in your car.

If you replace it, use a genuine Acurafloor mat that is designed to be usedwith the floor mat anchor in your car.

If you use a non-Acura floor mat inthe driver’s footwell, make sure itfits properly and that it can be usedwith the floor mat anchor.

Do not put additional floor mats ontop of the anchored mat, otherwisethe additional mats may slideforward and interfere with the pedals.

Carpeting Floor Mats

Appearance Care

Interior Care

272

00/12/25 14:38:32 31S0K630_275

Page 276: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Vacuum dirt and dust out of thematerial frequently. For generalcleaning, use a solution of mild soapand lukewarm water, letting it air dry.To clean off stubborn spots, use acommercially-available fabric cleaner.Test it on a hidden area of the fabricfirst, to make sure it does not bleachor stain the fabric. Follow theinstructions that come with thecleaner.

Remove dirt and dust with a vacuumcleaner. Wipe the vinyl with a softcloth dampened in a solution of mildsoap and water. Use the samesolution with a soft-bristle brush onmore difficult spots. You can also usecommercially-available spray orfoam-type vinyl cleaners.

Vacuum dirt and dust from theleather frequently. Pay particularattention to the pleats and seams.Clean the leather with a soft clothdampened with clear water, thenbuff it with a clean, dry cloth. Iffurther cleaning is needed, use asoap specifically for leather, such assaddle soap. Apply this soap with adamp, soft cloth. Wipe down andbuff as described above.

If your seat belts get dirty, you canuse a soft brush with a mixture ofmild soap and warm water to cleanthem. Do not use bleach, dye, orcleaning solvents. They can weakenthe belt material. Let the belts air-dry before you use the car.

CONTINUED

Fabric

Vinyl

Leather Seat Belts

Interior Care

Appearance Care 273

LLOOOOPP

00/12/25 14:38:44 31S0K630_276

Page 277: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Dirt build-up in the loops of the seatbelt anchors can cause the belts toretract slowly. Wipe the insides ofthe loops with a clean clothdampened in mild soap and warmwater or isopropyl alcohol.

Clean the windows, inside and out,with a commercially-available glasscleaner. You can also use a mixtureof one part white vinegar to ten partswater. This will remove the haze thatbuilds up on the inside of thewindows. Use a soft cloth or papertowels to clean all glass and clearplastic surfaces.

If you want to use an air freshener/deodorizer in the interior of your car,it is best to use a solid type. Someliquid air fresheners contain chemi-cals that may cause parts of theinterior trim and fabric to crack ordiscolor.

If you use a liquid air freshener,make sure you fasten it securely so itdoes not spill as you drive.

Windows Air Fresheners

Interior Care

Appearance Care274

The rear window defogger andantenna wires are bonded to the insideof the glass. Wiping vigorously up-and-down can dislodge and break thesewires. When cleaning the rear window,use gentle pressure and wipe side-to-side.

00/12/25 14:38:54 31S0K630_277

Page 278: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Repair chips and scratches in thepaint as soon as you discover them.

Inspect and clean out the drainholes in the bottom of the doorsand body.

Check the floor coverings fordampness. Carpeting and floormats may remain damp for a longtime, especially in winter. Thisdampness can eventually causethe floor panels to corrode.

Two factors normally contribute tocausing corrosion in your car:

Moisture trapped in body cavities.Dirt and road salt that collects inhollows on the underside of thecar stays damp, promotingcorrosion in that area.

Removal of paint and protectivecoatings from the exterior andunderside of the car.

Many corrosion-preventive measuresare built into your Acura. You canhelp keep your car from corrodingby performing some simple periodicmaintenance:

Use a high-pressure spray to cleanthe underside of your car. This isespecially important in areas thatuse road salt in winter. It is also agood idea in humid climates andareas subject to salt air. Be carefulof the ABS wheel sensors andwiring at each wheel.

Have the corrosion-preventivecoatings on the underside of yourcar inspected and repairedperiodically.

1.

2.

Corrosion Protection

Appearance Care 275

00/12/25 14:39:05 31S0K630_278

Page 279: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Make sure the repair facility usesgenuine Acura replacement bodyparts. Some companies make sheetmetal pieces that seem to duplicatethe original Acura body parts, butare actually inferior in fit, finish, andcorrosion resistance. Once installed,they do not give the same high-quality appearance.

When reporting your collision to theinsurance company, tell them youwant genuine Acura parts used in therepair. Although most insurersrecognize the quality of originalparts, some may try to specify thatthe repairs be done with otheravailable parts. You should investi-gate this before any repairs havebegun.

Body repairs can affect your car’sresistance to corrosion. If your carneeds repairs after a collision, payclose attention to the parts used inthe repair and the quality of thework.

Take your car to your authorizedAcura dealer for inspection after therepairs are completed. Your dealercan make sure that quality materialswere used, and that corrosion-preventive coatings were applied toall repaired and replaced parts.

Body Repairs

Appearance Care276

00/12/25 14:39:11 31S0K630_279

Page 280: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

This section covers the more-common problems that motoristsexperience with their vehicles. Itgives you information about how tosafely evaluate the problem and whatto do to correct it. If the problem hasstranded you on the side of the road,you may be able to get going again.If not, you will also find instructionson getting your car towed.

......................Compact Spare Tire . 278....................Changing a Flat Tire . 279

..........If Your Engine Won’t Start . 285Nothing Happens or theStarter Motor Operates

............................Very Slowly . 285The Starter Operates

................................Normally . 286

................................Jump Starting . 286............If Your Engine Overheats . 289

.........Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 291..........Charging System Indicator . 292

.......Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 293.......................Readiness Codes . 294

...............Brake System Indicator . 295..................Closing the Moonroof . 296

..............................................Fuses . 297..........Checking and Replacing . 298

......................Emergency Towing . 302

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Taking Care of the Unexpected 277

00/12/25 14:39:17 31S0K630_280

Page 281: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The compact spare tire has a shortertread life than a regular tire. Replaceit when you can see the tread wearindicator bars. The replacementshould be the same size and designtire, mounted on the same wheel.The compact spare tire is notdesigned to be mounted on a regularwheel, and the compact wheel is notdesigned for mounting a regular tire.

Check the inflation pressure of thecompact spare tire every time youcheck the other tires. It should beinflated to:

Your car has a compact spare tirethat takes up less space. Use thisspare tire as a temporary replace-ment only. Get your regular tirerepaired or replaced and put it backon your car as soon as you can.

Follow these precautions wheneveryou are using the compact spare tire:

Do not exceed 50 mph (80 km/h)under any circumstances.

This tire gives a harsher ride andless traction on some road sur-faces than the regular tire. Usegreater caution while driving onthis tire.

Do not mount snow chains on thecompact spare.

The wheel of the compact sparetire is designed especially to fityour car. Do not use your sparetire on another vehicle unless it isthe same make and model.

Turn off the Traction ControlSystem (see page ). Drivingwith the compact spare tire mayactivate the TCS.

Turn off the VSA system (seepage ).Driving with the compact sparetire may activate the VSA system.

194

197

Type S

Premium model

Compact Spare Tire

Taking Care of the Unexpected278

IINNDDIICCAATTOORR LLOOCCAATTIIOONN MMAARRKK

TTRREEAADD WWEEAARR IINNDDIICCAATTOORR BBAARR60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )

00/12/25 14:39:30 31S0K630_281

Page 282: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If you have a flat tire while driving,stop in a safe place to change it.Stopping in traffic or on the shoulderof a busy road is dangerous. Driveslowly along the shoulder until youget to an exit or an area to stop thatis far away from the traffic lanes.

Open the trunk. Raise the trunkfloor by lifting up on the back edge.To keep the trunk floor out of theway, attach the hook into the slotin the trunk lid.

The tools are in the tool box onthe right side of the trunk. Takethe tools out of the tool box.

Unscrew the wing bolt and takethe spare tire out of its well.

Park the car on firm, level, andnon-slippery ground away fromtraffic. Put the transmission inPark. Apply the parking brake.If you are towing a trailer, unhitchthe trailer.

Turn on the hazard warning lightsand turn the ignition switch toLOCK (0). Have all thepassengers get out of the car whileyou change the tire.

5.

4.

3.

2.

1.

CONTINUED

Changing a Flat Tire

Taking Care of the Unexpected 279

TTOOOOLL BBOOXX

HHOOOOKK TTRRUUNNKK FFLLOOOORR

SSPPAARREE TTIIRREE

JJAACCKK

The car can easily roll off thejack, seriously injuring anyoneunderneath.

Follow the directions forchanging a tire exactly, andnever get under the car when itis supported only by the jack.

00/12/25 14:39:43 31S0K630_282

Page 283: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Turn the jack’s end bracketcounterclockwise to loosen it, thenremove the jack.

The jack is behind a cover in theright fender. Remove the cover byturning the handle counterclock-wise, then pulling on the cover.

Loosen the five wheel nuts 1/2turn with the wheel wrench.

6. 7. 8.

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Changing a Flat Tire

280

JJAACCKK WWHHEEEELL NNUUTTSS

00/12/25 14:39:52 31S0K630_283

Page 284: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

Use the extension and wheelwrench as shown to raise thevehicle until the flat tire is off theground.

Locate the jacking point nearestthe tire you need to change. It ispointed to by an arrow molded intothe underside of the body. Placethe jack under the jacking point.Turn the end bracket clockwiseuntil the top of the jack contactsthe jacking point. Make sure thejacking point tab is resting in thejack notch.

Remove the wheel nuts and flattire. Temporarily place the flat tireon the ground with the outsidesurface of the wheel facing up.You could scratch the wheel if youput it face down.

9. 10. 11.

Changing a Flat Tire

Taking Care of the Unexpected 281

JJAACCKKIINNGG PPOOIINNTT WWHHEEEELL WWRREENNCCHH

EEXXTTEENNSSIIOONN

00/12/25 14:40:01 31S0K630_284

Page 285: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Put on the spare tire. Put thewheel nuts back on finger-tight,then tighten them in a crisscrosspattern with the wheel wrenchuntil the wheel is firmly againstthe hub. Do not try to tightenthem fully.

Before mounting the spare tire,wipe any dirt off the mountingsurface of the wheel and hub witha clean cloth. Wipe the hubcarefully, it may be hot fromdriving.

Lower the car to the ground andremove the jack.

12. 13. 14.

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Changing a Flat Tire

282

BBRRAAKKEE HHUUBB

00/12/25 14:40:10 31S0K630_285

Page 286: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Tighten the wheel nuts securely inthe same crisscross pattern. Havethe wheel nut torque checked atthe nearest automotive servicefacility.Tighten the wheel nuts to:

Place the flat tire face down in thespare tire well.

Remove the spacer cone from thewing bolt, turn it over, and put itback on the bolt.

Secure the flat tire by screwingthe wing bolt back into its hole.

Remove the center cap beforestoring the flat tire in the trunkwell.

15. 16. 17.

18.

19.

CONTINUED

Changing a Flat Tire

Taking Care of the Unexpected 283

WWIINNGG BBOOLLTT SSPPAACCEERRCCOONNEE

80 lbf·ft (108 N·m , 11 kgf·m)

00/12/25 14:40:21 31S0K630_286

Page 287: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Store the jack in its holder. Turnthe jack’s end bracket to lock it inplace. Replace the cover. Store thetools.

Unclip the hook from the trunk lidand lower the trunk floor.

Close the trunk lid.

Store the center cap in the trunk.Make sure it does not get scratch-ed or damaged.

20.

21.

22.

23.

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Changing a Flat Tire

284

Loose items can fly around theinterior in a crash and couldseriously injure the occupants.

Store the wheel, jack and toolssecurely before driving.

00/12/25 14:40:29 31S0K630_287

Page 288: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

When you turn the ignition switch toSTART (III), you do not hear thenormal noise of the engine trying tostart. You may hear a clicking soundor series of clicks, or nothing at all.Check these things:

Diagnosing why your engine won’tstart falls into two areas, dependingon what you hear when you turn thekey to START (III):

You hear nothing, or almostnothing. The engine’s startermotor does not operate at all, oroperates very slowly.

You can hear the starter motoroperating normally, or the startermotor sounds like it is spinningfaster than normal, but the enginedoes not start up and run.

Check the transmission interlock.The transmission must be in Parkor Neutral or the starter will notoperate.

Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).Turn on the headlights and checktheir brightness. If the headlightsare very dim or don’t light at all,the battery is discharged. See

on page .

Turn the ignition switch to START(III). If the headlights do not dim,check the condition of the fuses. Ifthe fuses are OK, there is proba-bly something wrong with theelectrical circuit for the ignitionswitch or starter motor. You willneed a qualified technician todetermine the problem. (See

on page .)

If the headlights dim noticeably orgo out when you try to start theengine, either the battery is dis-charged or the connections arecorroded. Check the condition ofthe battery and terminal connec-tions (see page ). You canthen try jump starting the car froma booster battery (see page ).286

302

243

286

If Your Engine Won’t Start

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Nothing Happens or the StarterMotor Operates Very Slowly

Jump Starting

Emergency Towing

285

00/12/25 14:40:40 31S0K630_288

Page 289: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

In this case, the starter motor’sspeed sounds normal, or even fasterthan normal, when you turn theignition switch to START (III), butthe engine does not run.

If your car’s battery has run down,you may be able to start the engineby using a booster battery. Althoughthis seems like a simple procedure,you should take several precautions.

You cannot start your Acura bypushing or pulling it.

If you find nothing wrong, you willneed a qualified technician to findthe problem. See

on page .

There may be an electricalproblem, such as no power to thefuel pump. Check all the fuses(see page ).

Do you have fuel? Turn theignition switch to ON (II) for aminute and watch the fuel gauge.The low fuel level warning lightmay not be working, so you werenot reminded to fill the tank.

Are you using the proper startingprocedure? Refer to

on page .

Your car has the ImmobilizerSystem. You should use aproperly-coded master or valet keyto start the engine (see page ).A key that is not properly codedwill cause the immobilizer systemindicator in the dash panel to blinkrapidly.

77

179

297

302

The Starter Operates Normally Jump Starting

EmergencyTowing

Starting theEngine

If Your Engine Won’t Start, Jump Starting

Taking Care of the Unexpected286

A battery can explode if you donot follow the correct procedure,seriously injuring anyonenearby.

Keep all sparks, open flames,and smoking materials awayfrom the battery.

00/12/25 14:40:53 31S0K630_289

Page 290: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

Connect the second jumper cableto the negative ( ) terminal onthe booster battery. Connect theother end to the grounding strapas shown. Do not connect thisjumper cable to any other part ofthe engine.

Remove the battery cover.

To jump start your car, follow thesedirections closely:

Open the hood and check thephysical condition of the battery(see page ). In very coldweather, check the condition ofthe electrolyte. If it seems slushyor like ice, do not try jump startinguntil it thaws.

Turn off all the electrical acces-sories: climate control, stereosystem, lights, etc.Put the transmission in Neutral orPark and set the parking brake.

Connect one jumper cable to thepositive ( ) terminal on yourAcura’s battery. Connect the otherend to the positive ( ) terminalon the booster battery.

4.

5.3.

1.

2.

243

Jump Starting

Taking Care of the Unexpected 287

PPrreemmiiuumm mmooddeell

If a battery sits in extreme cold, theelectrolyte inside can f reeze.Attempting to jump start with a f rozenbattery can cause it to rupture.

00/12/25 14:41:06 31S0K630_290

Page 291: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Once your car is running, discon-nect the negative cable from yourcar, then from the booster battery.Disconnect the positive cable fromyour car, then the booster battery.

The numbers in the illustration showyou the order to connect the jumpercables. Make sure to disconnect thecables in the reverse order.

Start your car. If the starter motorstill operates slowly, check thejumper cable connections to makesure they have good metal-to-metal contact.

Keep the ends of the jumper cablesaway from each other and any metalon the vehicle until all aredisconnected. Otherwise, you maycause an electrical short.

If the booster battery is in anothervehicle, have an assistant startthat vehicle and run it at a fast idle.

7.

8.

6.

Jump Starting

Taking Care of the Unexpected288

BBOOOOSSTTEERRBBAATTTTEERRYYTTyyppee SS

00/12/25 14:41:14 31S0K630_291

Page 292: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

The pointer of your car’s tempera-ture gauge should stay in the mid-range under most conditions. It maygo higher if you are driving up a longsteep hill on a very hot day. If itclimbs to the red mark, you shoulddetermine the reason.

Your car can overheat for severalreasons, such as lack of coolant or amechanical problem. The onlyindication may be the temperaturegauge climbing to or above the redmark. Or you may see steam orspray coming from under the car orengine cover. In either case, youshould take immediate action.

Safely pull to the side of the road.Put the transmission in Neutral orPark and set the parking brake.Turn off the climate control and allother accessories. Turn on thehazard warning indicators.

If you see steam and/or spraycoming from under the hood, turnoff the engine.

If you do not see steam or spray,leave the engine running andwatch the temperature gauge. Ifthe high heat is due to overloading(climbing a long, steep hill on ahot day with the A/C running, forexample), the engine should startto cool down almost immediately.If it does, wait until the tempera-ture gauge comes down to the mid-point then continue driving.

1.

2.

3.

If Your Engine Overheats

Taking Care of the Unexpected 289

Steam and spray from anoverheated engine canseriously scald you.

Do not open the hood if steamis coming out.

Driving with the temperature gaugepointer at the red mark can causeserious damage to your engine.

00/12/25 14:41:24 31S0K630_292

Page 293: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If the temperature gauge stays atthe red mark, turn off the engine.

Wait until you see no more signsof steam or spray, then open thehood.

Look for any obvious coolant leaks,such as a split radiator hose.Everything is still extremely hot,so use caution. If you find a leak, itmust be repaired before youcontinue driving (see

on page ).

If there was no coolant in thereserve tank, you may also have toadd coolant to the radiator. Let theengine cool down until the pointer

reaches the middle of the tempera-ture gauge, or lower, before check-ing the radiator.

Using gloves or a large heavycloth, turn the radiator capcounterclockwise, without pushingdown, to the first stop. Thisreleases any remaining pressure inthe cooling system. After thepressure releases, push down onthe cap and turn it until it comesoff.

If you don’t find an obvious leak,check the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank (see page

). If the level is below theMIN mark, add coolant to halfwaybetween the MIN and MAX marks.

Start the engine and set thetemperature control dial tomaximum (climate control toFULL AUTO at 90°F/32°C). Addcoolant to the radiator up to thebase of the filler neck. If you donot have the proper coolantmixture available, you can addplain water. Remember to havethe cooling system drained andrefilled with the proper mixture assoon as you can.

If the temperature stays normal,check the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. If it hasgone down, add coolant to theMAX mark. Put the cap back ontightly.

Put the radiator cap back ontightly. Run the engine and watchthe temperature gauge. If it goesback to the red mark, the engineneeds repair. (See

on page .)

4.

5.

6.

7.

8.

9.

11.

12.

10.

302

169 302

EmergencyTowing

EmergencyTowing

Taking Care of the Unexpected

If Your Engine Overheats

290

Removing the radiator capwhile the engine is hot cancause the coolant to spray out,seriously scalding you.

Always let the engine andradiator cool down beforeremoving the radiator cap.

00/12/25 14:41:36 31S0K630_293

Page 294: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

This indicator should light when theignition switch is ON (II), and go outafter the engine starts. It shouldnever come on when the engine isrunning. If it starts flashing, itindicates that the oil pressuredropped very low for a moment, thenrecovered. If the indicator stays onwith the engine running, it showsthat the engine has lost oil pressureand serious engine damage ispossible. In either case, you shouldtake immediate action.

Safely pull off the road and shutoff the engine. Turn on the hazardwarning indicators.

If necessary, add oil to bring thelevel back to the full mark on thedipstick (see page ).

Start the engine and watch the oilpressure indicator. If the lightdoes not go out within ten seconds,turn off the engine. There is amechanical problem that needs tobe repaired before you cancontinue driving. (See

on page .)

Let the car sit for a minute. Openthe hood and check the oil level(see page ). Although oil leveland oil pressure are not directlyconnected, an engine that is verylow on oil can lose pressure duringcornering and other drivingmaneuvers.

1.

2.

3.

4.

168

223

302

Low Oil Pressure Indicator

Taking Care of the Unexpected

EmergencyTowing

291

LLOOWW OOIILL PPRREESSSSUURREE IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

Running the engine with low oilpressure can cause serious mechanicaldamage almost immediately. Turn of fthe engine as soon as you can saf ely getthe car stopped.

00/12/25 14:41:46 31S0K630_294

Page 295: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

By eliminating as much of theelectrical load as possible, you candrive several miles (kilometers)before the battery is too dischargedto keep the engine running. Drive toa service station or garage whereyou can get technical assistance.

This indicator should come on whenthe ignition switch is ON (II), and goout after the engine starts. If itcomes on brightly when the engineis running, it indicates that thecharging system has stoppedcharging the battery.

Immediately turn off all electricalaccessories: radio, climate control,rear defogger, cruise control, etc.Try not to use other electrically-operated controls such as the powerwindows. Keep the engine runningand take extra care not to stall it.Starting the engine will dischargethe battery rapidly.

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Charging System Indicator

292

CCHHAARRGGIINNGG SSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

00/12/25 14:41:52 31S0K630_295

Page 296: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

This indicator comes on for a fewseconds when you turn the ignitionswitch ON (II). If it comes on at anyother time, it indicates one of theengine’s emissions control systemsmay have a problem. Even thoughyou may feel no difference in yourcar’s performance, it can reduceyour fuel economy and cause yourcar to put out excessive emissions.Continued operation may causeserious damage.

You should also have the dealerinspect your car if this indicatorcomes on repeatedly, even though itmay turn off as you continue driving.

If the indicator remains on past threedriving trips, or the fuel cap was notloose or missing, have the carchecked by the dealer as soon aspossible. Drive moderately until thedealer has inspected the problem.Avoid full-throttle acceleration anddriving at high speed.

If you have recently refueled yourcar, the cause of this indicatorcoming on could be a loose ormissing fuel fill cap. Check the capand tighten it until it clicks severaltimes. Replace the fuel fill cap if it ismissing. Tightening the cap will notmake the indicator turn offimmediately; it takes at least threedriving trips.

CONTINUED

Malfunction Indicator Lamp

Taking Care of the Unexpected 293

MMAALLFFUUNNCCTTIIOONN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR LLAAMMPP

If you keep driving with themalf unction indicator lamp on, you candamage your car’s emissions controlsand engine. Those repairs may not becovered by your car’s warranties.

00/12/25 14:42:01 31S0K630_296

Page 297: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Your car has certain ‘‘readinesscodes’’ that are part of the on-boarddiagnostics for the emissionssystems. In some states, part of theemissions testing is to make surethese codes are set. If they are notset, the test cannot be completed.

If your car’s battery has beendisconnected or gone dead, thesecodes are erased. It takes severaldays of driving under variousconditions to set the codes again.

If possible, do not take your vehiclefor a state emissions test until thereadiness codes are set. To check ifthey are set, turn the ignition ON (II),but do not start the engine. TheMalfunction Indicator Lamp willcome on for 20 seconds. If it thengoes off, the readiness codes are set.If it blinks 5 times, the readinesscodes are not set. Refer to StateEmissions Testing for moreinformation.(See page .)317

Malfunction Indicator Lamp

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Readiness Codes

294

00/12/25 14:42:08 31S0K630_297

Page 298: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If it comes on at any other time, itindicates a problem with the car’sbrake system. In most cases, theproblem is a low fluid level in thebrake fluid reservoir. Press lightly onthe brake pedal to see if it feelsnormal. If it does, check the brakefluid level the next time you stop at aservice station (see page ). If thefluid level is low, take the car to yourdealer and have the brake systeminspected for leaks or worn brakepads.

However, if the brake pedal does notfeel normal, you should takeimmediate action. Because of thebrake system’s dual-circuit design, aproblem in one part of the systemwill still give you braking at twowheels. You will feel the brake pedalgo down much farther before the carbegins to slow down, and you willhave to press harder on the pedal.The distance needed to stop will bemuch longer.

Slow down by shifting to a lowergear, and pull to the side of the roadwhen it is safe. Because of thelonger distance needed to stop, it ishazardous to drive the car. Youshould have it towed, and repaired assoon as possible. (See

on page .)

If you must drive the car a shortdistance in this condition, driveslowly and cautiously.

The Brake System Indicatornormally comes on when you turnthe ignition switch ON (II). It is areminder to check the parking brake.It comes on and stays lit if you do notfully release the parking brake.

If the ABS indicator and the VSAsystem indicator come on with thisindicator, have the car inspected byyour dealer immediately.

236302

Type S

EmergencyTowing

Brake System Indicator

Taking Care of the Unexpected 295

BBRRAAKKEE SSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

00/12/25 14:42:18 31S0K630_298

Page 299: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Use a screwdriver or coin toremove the round plug in thecenter of the headliner.

Remove the wrench. Replace theround plug.

If the electric motor will not closethe moonroof, do the following:

Check the fuse for the moonroofmotor (see page ). If the fuseis blown, replace it with one of thesame or lower rating.

Try closing the moonroof. If thenew fuse blows immediately or themoonroof motor still does notoperate, you can close themoonroof manually.

Insert the moonroof wrench intothe socket behind this plug. Turnthe wrench until the moonroof isfully closed.

Get the moonroof wrench out ofthe tool kit in the trunk.

5.

6.

4.

1.

2.

3.

297

Closing the Moonroof

Taking Care of the Unexpected296

SSOOCCKKEETTRROOUUNNDD PPLLUUGG

00/12/25 14:42:27 31S0K630_299

Page 300: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

All the electrical circuits in your carhave fuses to protect them from ashort circuit or overload. Thesefuses are located in three fuse boxes.

The interior fuse boxes are locatedon each side of the dashboard. Toopen an interior fuse box, open thecar door. Pull the bottom of thecover open, then take it out of itsside hinges by pulling it toward you.

The under-hood fuse box is locatedin the back of the engine compart-ment on the passenger’s side. Toopen it, push the tabs as shown.

The fuse box for the ABS is alsolocated in the engine compartmenton the driver’s side. To open it, pushthe tabs as shown.

CONTINUED

Fuses

Taking Care of the Unexpected 297

IINNTTEERRIIOORR

UUNNDDEERR--HHOOOODD TTAABB

TTAABB

AABBSS FFUUSSEE BBOOXX

00/12/25 19:41:53 31S0K630_300

Page 301: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Turn the ignition switch to LOCK(0). Make sure the headlights andall other accessories are off.

Remove the cover from the fusebox.

Check each of the large fuses inthe under-hood fuse box bylooking through the top at the wireinside. Removing these fusesrequires a Phillips-head screw-driver.

Check the smaller fuses in theunder-hood fuse box and all thefuses in the interior fuse boxes bypulling out each fuse with the fusepuller provided in the under-hoodfuse box.

If something electrical in your carstops working, the first thing youshould check for is a blown fuse.Determine from the chart on pages

and , or the diagram on thefuse box lid, which fuse or fusescontrol that component. Check thosefuses first, but check all the fusesbefore deciding that a blown fuse isnot the cause. Replace any blownfuses and check the component’soperation.

3.1.

2.

4.

300 302

Checking and Replacing Fuses

Fuses

Taking Care of the Unexpected298

FFUUSSEE PPUULLLLEERRBBLLOOWWNN

FFUUSSEE

00/12/25 14:42:48 31S0K630_301

Page 302: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Look for a burned wire inside thefuse. If it is burned, replace it withone of the spare fuses of the samerating or lower.

If the replacement fuse of thesame rating blows in a short time,there is probably a seriouselectrical problem in your car.Leave the blown fuse in thatcircuit and have your car checkedby a qualified mechanic.

If you cannot drive the car withoutfixing the problem, and you do nothave a spare fuse, take a fuse of thesame rating or a lower rating fromone of the other circuits. Make sureyou can do without that circuittemporarily (such as the accessorypower socket or radio).

If you replace the blown fuse with aspare fuse that has a lower rating, itmight blow out again. This does notindicate anything wrong. Replace thefuse with one of the correct rating assoon as you can.

If the radio fuse is removed, theaudio system will disable itself. Thenext time you turn on the radio youwill see ‘‘Code’’ in the frequencydisplay. Use the Preset buttons toenter the five-digit code (see page

).

5.

6.

151

CONTINUED

Fuses

Taking Care of the Unexpected 299

BBLLOOWWNN

Replacing a fuse with one that has ahigher rating greatly increases thechances of damaging the electricalsystem. If you do not have a replace-ment f use with the proper rating f or thecircuit, install one with a lower rating.

00/12/25 14:42:58 31S0K630_302

Page 303: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

**

Amps.No. Circuits ProtectedNo. Amps. Circuits Protected

No. Amps. Circuits Protected

20 A30 A

120 A30 A20 A15 A30 A15 A20 A20 A20 A

20 A

13131415161718192021222324

Cooling FanCooling FanBatterySpare FuseSpare FuseHazardVSA Throttle MotorACG SStopTCS, VSA F/SRight HeadlightNot UsedLeft Headlight

1123456789101112

20 A30 A15 A60 A40 A40 A20 A40 A40 A40 A15 A10 A7.5 A

Condenser FanCondenser FanSmall LightIG1 MainRear Window DefoggerHeater MotorFog LightPower SeatPower Window MotorBack Up, ACCSpare FuseSpare FuseSpare Fuse

123

40 A20 A7.5 A

ABS MotorABS F/SABS Motor Check

1 : Premium model2 : Type S only

1

2

2

1

2

Fuses

Taking Care of the Unexpected300

UNDER-HOOD FUSE BOX

ABS FUSE BOX

00/12/25 14:43:10 31S0K630_303

Page 304: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

←← →→

**

Amps.No. Circuits ProtectedNo. Amps.Circuits Protected

:

15 A10 A7.5 A

7.5 A7.5 A15 A

7.5 A7.5 A7.5 A

7.5 A15 A30 A7.5 A

123

456

789

10111213

On Canadian models

Driver’s Power Window

Heated SeatDriver’s Power Seat Slide

Passenger’s Power SeatRecliningRear Left Power WindowFront Right Power WindowACC (Radio)Navigation System, DaytimeRunning LightsInterior Light, CourtesyLightsPower Door LocksClock, Back upA/C Mg ClutchMoonroofRear Right Power Window

123456

78910

11

1213141516

20 A20 A20 A20 A20 A20 A

20 A20 A20 A10 A

7.5 A

20 A7.5 A7.5 A30 A20 A

On Canadian models

Fuel PumpSRSHeater Control, A/C ClutchRelay, Cooling Fan RelayR/C MirrorDaytime Running LightsECU (ECM/PCM), CruiseControlMoonroofACC Relay, NavigationInstrument Panel, Back-upLights, Memory SeatTurn SignalsIG CoilWiper, WasherStarter Signal

Type S only1 :2 :

Driver’s Power Seat Reclining

Passenger’s Power Seat Slide

1

2

Fuses

Taking Care of the Unexpected 301

INTERIOR FUSE BOXES

Driver’s Side Passenger’s Side

FFrroonntt FFrroonntt

00/12/25 14:43:22 31S0K630_304

Page 305: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If your car needs to be towed, call aprofessional towing service or, if youbelong to one, an organization thatprovides roadside assistance. Nevertow your car behind another vehiclewith just a rope or chain. It is verydangerous.

There are three popular types ofprofessional towing equipment.

The operatorloads your car on the back of a truck.

The towtruck uses metal cables with hookson the ends. These hooks go aroundparts of the frame or suspension andthe cables lift that end of the car offthe ground. Your car’s suspensionand body can be seriously damaged.

If your Acura cannot be transportedby flat-bed, it should be towed bywheel-lift equipment with the frontwheels off the ground. If, due todamage, your car must be towedwith the front wheels on the ground,do the following.

Release the parking brake.Start the engine.Shift to D , then to N.Turn off the engine.

The towtruck uses two pivoting arms that gounder the tires (front or rear) and liftthem off the ground. The other twotires remain on the ground.

With the front wheels on the ground,it is best to tow the car no fartherthan 50 miles (80 km), and keep thespeed below 35 mph (55 km/h).

5

Flat-bed Equipment

Sling-type Equipment

Wheel-lif t Equipment

This is the best way to transportyour Acura.

This method of towing isunacceptable.

This isan acceptable way to tow yourAcura.

Emergency Towing

Taking Care of the Unexpected302

Improper towing preparation willdamage the transmission. Follow theabove procedure exactly. If you cannotshif t the transmission or start theengine, your car must be transportedwith the f ront wheels of f the ground.

00/12/25 14:43:33 31S0K630_305

Page 306: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If you decide to tow your car with allfour wheels on the ground, makesure you use a properly-designed andattached tow bar. Prepare the car fortowing as described above, and leavethe ignition switch in Accessory (I)so the steering wheel does not lock.Make sure the radio and any itemsplugged into the accessory powersocket are turned off so they do notrun down the battery.

Emergency Towing

Taking Care of the Unexpected 303

Trying to lif t or tow your car by thebumpers will cause serious damage.The bumpers are not designed tosupport the car’s weight.

The steering system can be damaged ifthe steering wheel is locked. Leave theignition switch in Accessory (I), andmake sure the steering wheel turnsf reely bef ore you begin towing.

00/12/25 14:43:39 31S0K630_306

Page 307: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

304

Page 308: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

--

The diagrams in this section giveyou the dimensions and capacities ofyour Acura, and the locations of theidentification numbers. It alsoincludes information you shouldknow about your vehicle’s tires andemissions control systems.

................Identification Numbers . 306................................Specifications . 308

DOT Tire Quality Grading.............................(U.S. Cars) . 310

.................................Treadwear . 310.............Traction AA, A, B, C . 310.............Temperature A, B, C . 311

.........................Oxygenated Fuels . 312......Driving in Foreign Countries . 313

.......................Emissions Controls . 314.....................The Clean Air Act . 314

Crankcase Emissions Control....................................System . 314

Evaporative Emissions Control....................................System . 314

Onboard Refueling Vapor................................Recovery . 314

...Exhaust Emissions Controls . 315....................PGM-FI System . 315

Ignition Timing Control................................System . 315

Exhaust Gas Recirculation...................(EGR) System . 315

Three Way Catalytic...........................Converter . 315

....................Replacement Parts . 315..Three Way Catalytic Converter . 316

..............State Emissions Testing . 317

Technical Information

Technical Information 305

00/12/25 14:43:46 31S0K630_308

Page 309: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Your car has several identifyingnumbers located in various places.

The Vehicle Identification Number(VIN) is the 17-digit number yourAcura dealer uses to register yourcar for warranty purposes. It is alsonecessary for licensing and insuringyour car. The easiest place to findthe VIN is on a plate fastened to thetop of the dashboard. You can see itby looking through the windshieldon the driver’s side. It is also on theCertification label attached to thedriver’s doorjamb, and is stamped onthe engine compartment bulkhead.The VIN is also provided in bar codeon the Certification label.

Identif ication Numbers

Technical Information306

CCEERRTTIIFFIICCAATTIIOONN LLAABBEELL

VVEEHHIICCLLEE IIDDEENNTTIIFFIICCAATTIIOONN NNUUMMBBEERR

00/12/25 14:43:52 31S0K630_309

Page 310: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The Transmission Number is on alabel on top of the transmission.

The Engine Number is stamped intothe engine block. It is on the front.

Identif ication Numbers

Technical Information 307

AAUUTTOOMMAATTIICC TTRRAANNSSMMIISSSSIIOONN NNUUMMBBEERR

EENNGGIINNEE NNUUMMBBEERR

00/12/25 14:43:58 31S0K630_310

Page 311: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

- -

Specifications

Technical Information308

Dimensions

Weights

Air Conditioning

Capacities

Capacities

192.5 in (4,890 mm)70.7 in (1,795 mm)55.7 in (1,415 mm)108.1 in (2,745 mm)61.2 in (1,555 mm)60.4 in (1,535 mm)

1.48 US gal (5.6 , 1.23 Imp gal)1.98 US gal (7.5 , 1.65 Imp gal)

4.6 US qt (4.4 , 3.9 Imp qt)

4.2 US qt (4.0 , 3.5 Imp qt)

5.3 US qt (5.0 , 4.4 Imp qt)3.1 US qt (2.9 , 2.6 Imp qt)7.6 US qt (7.2 , 6.3 Imp qt)

2.6 US qt (2.5 , 2.2 Imp qt)4.8 US qt (4.5 , 4.0 Imp qt)

Including the coolant in the reserve tank and that remaining in theengine.Reserve tank capacity: 0.16 US gal (0.6 , 0.13 Imp gal)Excluding the oil remaining in the engine.

HFC-134a (R-134a)25 27 oz (700 750 g)

ND-OIL8

LengthWidthHeightWheelbaseTrack

Gross vehicle weight rating See the certification label attachedto the driver’s doorjamb.

Refrigerant typeCharge quantityLubricant type

Fuel tank

EnginecoolantEngine oil

AutomatictransmissionfluidWindshieldwasherreservoir

Approx.

FrontRear

ChangeTotalChange

IncludingfilterWithoutfilter

TotalChangeTotal

U.S. CarsCanada Cars

1 :

2 :17.17 US gal (65.0 , 14.30 Imp gal)

1

2

00/12/25 14:44:13 31S0K630_311

Page 312: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

--

-----------

**

**

Specifications

Technical Information 309

Fuses

Battery

Lights Engine

Alignment

Tires

3.50 x 3.39 in (89.0 x 86.0 mm)

12 V 60 W (HB3)12 V 24/2.2 CP

195.8 cu-in (3,210 cm )9.8 : 1

Water cooled 4-strokeSOHC VTEC 6-cylinder (V6),

gasoline engine

Interior

Under-hood See page 300 or the fuse boxcover.

See page 301 or the fuse labelattached to the inside of the fusebox door on each side of thedashboard.

Capacity 12 V 65 AH/20 HR

HeadlightsFront turn signal/Side marker/Parking lightsFog LightsRear turn signal lightsStop/TaillightsHigh-mount brake lightBack-up lightsLicense plate lightCeiling lightTrunk lightDoor courtesy lightsVanity mirror lightsSpotlights 12 V

12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V

4 CP1.1 W2 CP5 W7 W3 CP18 W21 W21/5 W21 W

Type

Bore x StrokeDisplacementCompression ratio

Spark plugs See spark plug maintenancesection page 242 .

10.5 : 1

12 V 51 W (HB4)

Toe-in

Camber

Caster

Size

Pressure

3°00’0°30’0°

0.08 in (2.0 mm)0.00 in (0.0 mm)

60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )

T135/80R16 101MP215/50R17 93VP205/60R16 91V

FrontRearFrontRearFront

(High beam)

Low beam headlight bulbs are a type of high voltage discharge tube.

Front/Rear

SpareFront/RearSpare

2 : Type S1 : Premium model

1 : Premium model2 : Type S

2

1

2

1

00/12/25 14:44:41 31S0K630_312

Page 313: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

-The traction grades, from highest tolowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Thosegrades represent the tire’s ability tostop on wet pavement as measuredunder controlled conditions onspecified government test surfacesof asphalt and concrete. A tiremarked C may have poor tractionperformance.

Warning: The traction gradeassigned to this tire is based onstraight-ahead braking traction tests,and does not include acceleration,cornering, hydroplaning, or peaktraction characteristics.

The treadwear grade is a compara-tive rating based on the wear rate ofthe tire when tested under controlledconditions on a specified governmenttest course. For example, a tiregraded 150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on thegovernment course as a tire graded100. The relative performance oftires depends upon the actual condi-tions of their use, however, and maydepart significantly from the normdue to variations in driving habits,service practices and differences inroad characteristics and climate.

The tires on your car meet all U.S.Federal Safety Requirements. Alltires are also graded for treadwear,traction, and temperature perform-ance according to Department ofTransportation (DOT) standards.The following explains thesegradings.

Quality grades can be found whereapplicable on the tire sidewallbetween the tread shoulder and themaximum section width. Forexample:

Technical Information

DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Cars)

Treadwear Traction AA, A, B, C

Treadwear 200Traction AATemperature A

Uniform Tire Quality Grading

310

00/12/25 14:44:53 31S0K630_313

Page 314: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

-The temperature grades are A (thehighest), B, and C, representing thetire’s resistance to the generation ofheat and its ability to dissipate heatwhen tested under controlledconditions on a specified indoorlaboratory test wheel. Sustained hightemperature can cause the materialof the tire to degenerate and reducetire life, and excessive temperaturecan lead to sudden tire failure. Thegrade C corresponds to a level ofperformance which all passenger cartires must meet under the FederalMotor Vehicle Safety Standard No.109. Grades B and A representhigher levels of performance on thelaboratory test wheel than theminimum required by law.

Warning: The temperature grade forthis tire is established for a tire thatis properly inflated and not over-loaded. Excessive speed, underinfla-tion, or excessive loading, eitherseparately or in combination, cancause heat buildup and possible tirefailure.

DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Cars)

Technical Information

Temperature A, B, C

311

00/12/25 14:44:59 31S0K630_314

Page 315: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Some conventional gasolines arebeing blended with alcohol or anether compound. These gasolinesare collectively referred to asoxygenated fuels. To meet clean airstandards, some areas of the UnitedStates and Canada use oxygenatedfuels to help reduce emissions.

If you use an oxygenated fuel, besure it is unleaded and meets theminimum octane rating requirement.

Before using an oxygenated fuel, tryto confirm the fuel’s contents. Somestates/provinces require thisinformation to be posted on thepump.

The following are the U.S. EPA andCanadian CGSB approvedpercentages of oxygenates:

If you notice any undesirableoperating symptoms, try anotherservice station or switch to anotherbrand of gasoline.

Fuel system damage or performanceproblems resulting from the use ofan oxygenated fuel containing morethan the percentages of oxygenatesgiven above are not covered underwarranty.

(methyl or woodalcohol)Your vehicle was not designed to usefuel that contains methanol.Methanol can corrode metal parts inthe fuel system, and also damageplastic and rubber components. Thisdamage would not be covered byyour warranties.

(Methyl Tertiary ButylEther)You may use gasoline containing upto 15 percent MTBE by volume.

(ethyl or grain alcohol)You may use gasoline containing upto 10 percent ethanol by volume.Gasoline containing ethanol may bemarketed under the name ‘‘Gasohol.’’

Oxygenated Fuels

Technical Information

METHANOL

MTBE

ETHANOL

312

00/12/25 14:45:10 31S0K630_315

Page 316: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

If you are planning to take yourAcura outside the U.S. or Canada,contact the tourist bureaus in theareas you will be traveling in to findout about the availability of unleadedgasoline with the proper octanerating.

If unleaded gasoline is not available,be aware that using leaded gasolinein your Acura will affect perfor-mance and fuel mileage, and damageits emissions controls. It will nolonger comply with U.S. andCanadian emissions regulations, andwill be illegal to operate in NorthAmerica. To bring your car back intocompliance will require the replace-ment of several components, such asthe oxygen sensors and the threeway catalytic converter. These re-placements are not covered underwarranty.

Driving in Foreign Countries

Technical Information 313

00/12/25 14:45:15 31S0K630_316

Page 317: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The burning of gasoline in your car’sengine produces several byproducts.Some of these are carbon monoxide(CO), oxides of nitrogen (NOx) andhydrocarbons (HC). Gasolineevaporating from the tank alsoproduces hydrocarbons. Controllingthe production of NOx, CO, and HCis important to the environment.Under certain conditions of sunlightand climate, NOx and HC react toform photochemical ‘‘smog.’’ Carbonmonoxide does not contribute tosmog creation, but it is a poisonousgas.

The United States Clean Air Actsets standards for automobileemissions. It also requires thatautomobile manufacturers explain toowners how their emissions controlswork and what to do to maintainthem. This section summarizes howthe emissions controls work.Scheduled maintenance is on page

.

In Canada, Acura vehicles complywith the Canadian Motor VehicleSafety Standards (CMVSS) forEmissions valid at the time they aremanufactured.

Your car has a Positive CrankcaseVentilation System. This keepsgasses that build up in the engine’scrankcase from going into theatmosphere. The Positive CrankcaseVentilation valve routes them from

the crankcase back to the intakemanifold. They are then drawn intothe engine and burned.

As gasoline evaporates in the fueltank, an evaporative emissionscontrol canister filled with charcoaladsorbs the vapor. It is stored in thiscanister while the engine is off. Afterthe engine is started and warmed up,the vapor is drawn into the engineand burned during driving.

The Onboard Refueling VaporRecovery (ORVR) system capturesthe fuel vapors during refueling. Thevapors are adsorbed in a canisterfilled with activated carbon. Whiledriving, the fuel vapors are drawninto the engine and burned off.

214

The Clean Air Act

Crankcase Emissions ControlSystem

Evaporative Emissions ControlSystem

Onboard Refueling VaporRecovery

Technical Information

Emissions Controls

314

00/12/25 14:45:26 31S0K630_317

Page 318: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

The exhaust emissions controlsinclude four systems: PGM-FI,Ignition Timing Control, ExhaustGas Recirculation and Three WayCatalytic Converter. These foursystems work together to control theengine’s combustion and minimizethe amount of HC, CO, and NOx thatcomes out the tailpipe. The exhaustemissions control systems areseparate from the crankcase andevaporative emissions controlsystems.

The emissions control systems arecovered by warranties separate fromthe rest of your car. Read yourwarranty manual for more informa-tion.The PGM-FI System uses sequential

multiport fuel injection.It has three subsystems: Air Intake,Engine Control, and Fuel Control.The Powertrain Control Module(PCM) uses various sensors todetermine how much air is goinginto the engine. It then controls howmuch fuel to inject under all operat-ing conditions.

This system constantly adjusts theignition timing, reducing the amountof HC, CO and NOx produced.

The Exhaust Gas Recirculation(EGR) system takes some of theexhaust gas and routes it back intothe intake manifold. Adding exhaustgas to the air/fuel mixture reducesthe amount of NOx produced whenthe fuel is burned.

The emissions control systems aredesigned and certified to work to-gether in reducing emissions tolevels that comply with the Clean AirAct. To make sure the emissionsremain low, you should use only newGenuine Honda replacement parts ortheir equivalent for repairs. Usinglower quality parts may increase theemissions from your car.

The three way catalytic converter isin the exhaust system. Throughchemical reactions, it converts HC,CO, and NOx in the engine’s exhaustto carbon dioxide (CO ), dinitrogen(N ), and water vapor.

2

2

Exhaust Emissions Controls Replacement Parts

PGM-FI System

Ignition Timing Control System

Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)System

Three Way Catalytic Converter

Emissions Controls

Technical Information 315

00/12/25 14:45:40 31S0K630_318

Page 319: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Keep the engine tuned-up.

Always use unleaded gasoline.Even a small amount of leadedgasoline can contaminate thecatalyst metals, making the threeway catalytic converter ineffective.

The three way catalytic convertercontains platinum, palladium andrhodium. These metals serve ascatalysts, promoting chemicalreactions to convert the exhaustgasses without affecting the metals.The catalytic converter is referred toas a three-way catalyst, since it actson HC, CO, and NOx. A replacementunit must be an original Acura partor its equivalent.

The three way catalytic convertermust operate at a high temperaturefor the chemical reactions to takeplace. It can set on fire any com-bustible materials that come near it.Park your car away from high grass,dry leaves, or other flammables.

A defective three way catalyticconverter contributes to air pollution,and can impair your engine’s per-formance. Follow these guidelines toprotect your car’s three way catalyticconverter.

Have your car diagnosed andrepaired if it is misfiring, back-firing, stalling, or otherwise notrunning properly.

Three Way Catalytic Converter

Technical Information316

TTHHRREEEE WWAAYY CCAATTAALLYYTTIICC CCOONNVVEERRTTEERR

00/12/25 14:45:50 31S0K630_319

Page 320: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

If you take your vehicle for a stateemissions test shortly after thebattery has been disconnected orgone dead, it may not pass the test.This is because of certain ‘‘readinesscodes’’ that must be set in the on-board diagnostics for the emissionssystems. These codes are erasedwhen the battery is disconnected,and set again only after several daysof driving under a variety ofconditions.

If the testing facility determines thatthe readiness codes are not set, youwill be requested to return at a laterdate to complete the test. If you mustget the vehicle re-tested within thenext two or three days, you cancondition the vehicle for re-testingby doing the following.

Make sure the gas tank is nearly,but not completely, full (around3/4).

Make sure the vehicle has beenparked with the engine off for 8hours or more.

Make sure the ambienttemperature is between 20° and95°F.

Without touching the acceleratorpedal, start the engine and let itidle for 20 seconds.

Keep the vehicle in Park .Increase the engine speed to 2,000rpm and hold it there until thetemperature gauge rises to at least1/4 of the scale (approximately 3minutes).

Technical Information

State Emissions Testing

Testing of Readiness Codes

317

00/12/25 14:46:00 31S0K630_320

Page 321: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Select a nearby lightly traveledmajor highway where you canmaintain a speed of 50 to 60 mphfor at least 20 minutes. Drive onthe highway in D . Do not use thecruise control. When traffic allows,drive for 90 seconds withoutmoving the accelerator pedal.(Vehicle speed may vary slightly;this is okay.) If you cannot do thisfor a continuous 90 secondsbecause of traffic conditions, drivefor at least 30 seconds, then repeatit two more times (for a total of 90seconds).

Then drive in city/suburbantraffic for at least 10 minutes.When traffic conditions allow, letthe vehicle coast for severalseconds without using theaccelerator pedal or the brakepedal.

If the testing facility determines thereadiness codes are still not set, seeyour Acura dealer.

5

State Emissions Testing

Technical Information318

00/12/25 14:46:05 31S0K630_321

Page 322: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Customer Relations................................Information . 320

.............Canada Zone Office Map . 321....................Warranty Coverages . 322

Reporting Safety Defects..........................(U.S. Vehicles) . 323

Warranty and Customer Relations

Warranty and Customer Relations 319

00/12/25 14:46:09 31S0K630_322

Page 323: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

When you call or write, please giveus this information:

Acura dealership personnel aretrained professionals. They shouldbe able to answer all your questions.If you encounter a problem that yourdealership does not solve to yoursatisfaction, please discuss it withthe dealership’s management. TheService Manager or GeneralManager can help. Almost allproblems are solved in this way.

If you are dissatisfied with thedecision made by the dealership’smanagement, contact the AcuraCustomer Relations Office.

U.S. Owners:Acura Automobile Division

Client Services OfficeAmerican Honda Motor Co., Inc.

1919 Torrance Blvd.Torrance, CA 90501-2746

or telephone: (800) 382-2238

In Puerto Rico and the U.S. VirginIslands:

Vortex Motor Corp.Bella InternationalP.O. Box 190816

San Juan, PR 00919-0816(787) 250-4327

Canadian Owners:Refer to the Canadian Zone OfficeMap on the next page.

Vehicle Identification Number(see page )Name and address of the dealerwho services your carDate of purchaseMileage on your carYour name, address, and tele-phone numberA detailed description of theproblemName of the dealer who sold thecar to you

306

Warranty and Customer Relations

Customer Relations Information

320

00/12/25 14:46:19 31S0K630_323

Page 324: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Canada Zone Office Map

Warranty and Customer Relations 321

Honda Canada Inc.National Office

CUSTOMER RELATIONSRELATIONS AVEC LA CLIENTÈLE

Honda Canada Inc.715 Milner AvenueToronto, ONM1B 2K8

Tel: 1-888-9-ACURA-9

Fax: Toll-free 1-877-939-0909Toronto (416) 287-4776

00/12/25 14:46:24 31S0K630_324

Page 325: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

a seatbelt that fails to function properly iscovered for the useful life of thevehicle.

all exterior body panels arecovered for rust-through from theinside for the specified time periodwith no mileage limit.

Your new Acura is covered by thesewarranties:

genuine Acura Accessories arecovered under this warranty. Timeand mileage limits depend on thetype of accessory and other factors.Please read your warranty manualfor details.

covers all genuineAcura replacement parts againstdefects in materials and workman-ship.

provides proratedcoverage for a replacement batterypurchased from an Acura dealer.

covers your new vehicle, except forthe battery, emissions controlsystems and accessories, againstdefects in materials andworkmanship.

these twowarranties cover your vehicle’s emis-sions control systems. Time, mileage,and coverage are conditional. Pleaseread the warranty manual for exactinformation.

this warranty gives upto 100 percent credit toward areplacement battery.

providescoverage for as long as the pur-chaser of the muffler owns thevehicle.

Please refer to the 2002 WarrantyManual that came with your car.

Restrictions and exclusions apply toall these warranties. Please read the2002 Acura Warranty Informationbooklet that came with your car forprecise information on warrantycoverages. Your Acura’s originaltires are covered by theirmanufacturer. Tire warrantyinformation is in a separate booklet.

Seat Belt Limited Warranty

Rust Perforation Limited Warranty

Accessory Limited Warranty

Replacement Parts LimitedWarranty

Replacement Battery LimitedWarranty

New Vehicle Limited Warranty

Emissions Control Systems DefectsWarranty and EmissionsPerformance Warranty

Original Equipment Battery LimitedWarranty

Replacement Muffler LifetimeLimited Warranty

U.S. Owners

Canadian Owners

Warranty Coverages

Warranty and Customer Relations322

00/12/25 14:46:38 31S0K630_325

Page 326: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

To contact NHTSA, you may eithercall the Auto Safety Hotline toll-freeat 1-800-424-9393 (or 366-0123 inWashington D.C. area) or write to:NHTSA, U.S. Department ofTransportation, Washington,D.C. 20590. You can also obtainother information about motorvehicle safety from the Hotline.

If you believe that your vehicle has adefect which could cause a crash orcould cause injury or death, youshould immediately inform theNational Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration (NHTSA) in additionto notifying Acura AutomobileDivision, American Honda Motor Co.,Inc.

If NHTSA receives similar com-plaints, it may open an investigation,and if it finds that a safety defectexists in a group of vehicles, it mayorder a recall and remedy campaign.However, NHTSA cannot becomeinvolved in individual problemsbetween you, your dealer, or AcuraAutomobile Division, AmericanHonda Motor Co., Inc.

Warranty and Customer Relations

Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Vehicles)

323

00/12/25 14:46:43 31S0K630_326

Page 327: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

324

Page 328: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

*2002

ACU

The following publications covering the operation andservicing of your vehicle can be obtained from HelmIncorporated, either by filling out the attached form or,for credit card holders, calling the toll-free phone numberon the form. For manuals prior to the year shown below,contact Helm Incorporated, P.O. Box 07280, Detroit,Michigan 48207, or call 1-800-782-4356.

Valid only for sales within the U.S. Canadian owners shouldcontact their authorized Acura dealer.

Authorized Manuals

Purchasing Factory Authorized Manuals(U.S. only)

325

ORDER TOLL FREE: 1-800-782-4356

OR

(NOTE: For Credit Card Holder Orders Only)

MINIMUM CREDIT CARD PURCHASE $10.00

Publication

Form Number

61S0K02

61S0K03

61S0K03EL

61S0K30

31S0K630

31S0K730

ACU-R

Form Description

1999-2001 Acura 3.2 TL

Service Manual

2002 Acura 3.2 TL

Service Manual Supplement

1999-2002 Acura 3.2 TL

Electrical Troubleshooting Manual

1999-2002 Acura 3.2 TL

Body Repair Manual

2002 Acura 3.2 TL

Owner’s Manual

2002 Acura 3.2 TL

Navigation Manual

Order Form for Previous Years-

Indicate Year and Model Desired

Price

Each

$67.00

$36.00

$45.00

$42.00

$35.00

$27.00

FREE

PUBLICATION NUMBERVEHICLE MODEL

Name YearQty

Price

Each

Total

Price

GRAND TOTAL

HANDLING CHARGE

Mich. Purchases

Add 6% Sales Tax

TOTAL MATERIAL

$6.00

Monday-Friday 8:00 A.M. 6:00 P.M. EST

By completing this form you can order the materials desired. You canpay by check or money order, or charge to your credit card. Mail toHelm Incorporated at the address shown on the back of the order form.

Prices are subject to change withoutnotice and without incurring obligation.

Orders are mailed within 10 days. Pleaseallow adequate time for delivery.

Prices are subject to change without notice and without incurringobligation.

00/12/25 14:46:57 31S0K630_328

Page 329: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

SHIP

TO

PAYMENT

This manual complements the Service Manual byproviding in-depth troubleshooting information for eachelectrical circuit in your vehicle.

This manual describes the procedures involved in thereplacement of damaged body parts.

This manual covers maintenance and recommendedprocedures for repair to engine and chassis components.It is written for the Journeyman mechanic, but is simpleenough for most mechanically-inclined owners to under-stand.

Authorized Manuals

Service Manual:

Electrical Troubleshooting Manual:

Body Repair Manual:

326

NOTE: Dealers and Companies please provide dealer or company name,and also the name of the person to whose attention the shipment shouldbe sent. For purchases outside U.S.A. please write to the address shownbelow for a quotation.

P.O. BOX 07280·DETROIT, MICHIGAN 48207·1-800-782-4356

Customer Name Attention

Apartment Number

State & Zip CodeCity

Daytime Telephone Number

Check or money order enclosed payable to Helm Inc U.S. funds only.Do not send cash

MasterCard

VISA Check here if your billing address is differentfrom the shipping address shown above.

Account Number Expiration: Mo. Yr.

CUSTOMER SIGNATURE DATE

Street Address No P.O. Box Number

( )

These Publications cannot be returned for credit without receiving advance authorization within 14days of delivery. On returns, a restocking fee may be applied against the original order.

00/12/25 14:47:08 31S0K630_329

Page 330: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

...Accessories and Modifications . 171................................Accessories . 171

.Additional Safety Precautions . 172............................Modifications . 172

ACCESSORY (Ignition Key.......................................Position) . 79

............Accessory Power Sockets . 110....................Additives, Engine Oil . 225

...............................Airbag (SRS) . 9, 47.....................Air Cleaner Element . 238

.................Air Conditioning Filter . 249......Air Conditioning System . 116, 123

..............................Maintenance . 248.................................Usage . 118, 123

.......................Air Pressure, Tires . 251

.......................Alcohol in Gasoline . 312......................................Antifreeze . 228

Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)...............................Indicator . 60, 192

...................................Operation . 191..............Anti-theft, Audio System . 151

.Anti-theft Steering Column Lock . 78..........................Appearance Care . 269

................................Audio System . 129

...Automatic Lighting Off Feature . 70

...Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners . 45.............Automatic Speed Control . 153..............Automatic Transmission . 180

..........................Capacity, Fluid . 308...............Checking Fluid Level . 234

.......................................Shifting . 180.Shift Lever Position Indicator . 180

................Shift Lever Positions . 181....................Shift Lock Release . 187

BatteryCharging System

...........................Indicator . 59, 292............................Jump Starting . 286

..............................Maintenance . 243............................Specifications . 309

..............................Before Driving . 163....................................Belts, Seat . 8, 44

...........................Beverage Holder . 108...................................Body Repair . 276

Brakes...........Anti-lock System (ABS) . 191

.............Break-in, New Linings . 164

....................Bulb Replacement . 263...........................................Fluid . 236

.......................................Parking . 104.................System Indicator . 59, 295........................Wear Indicators . 190

.............................Braking System . 190........................Break-in, New Car . 164

..Brightness Control, Instruments . 71........................Brights, Headlights . 69

Bulb Replacement..........................Back-up Lights . 263

..............................Brake Lights . 263

..............................Ceiling Light . 265........................Courtesy Lights . 265

.................................Fog Lights . 262........Front Side Marker Lights . 260

.................................Headlights . 259.........High-mount Brake Light . 264

...................License Plate Light . 264............................Specifications . 309

...................................Spotlights . 265....................Turn Signal Lights . 260

..............................Bulbs, Halogen . 259

Index

A

B

I

00/12/26 11:14:29 31S0K630_330

Page 331: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

............................Capacities Chart . 308.............Carbon Monoxide Hazard . 53

............................Carrying, Cargo . 173Cassette Player

............................................Care . 141...................................Operation . 137

..............CAUTION, Explanation of . ii...................................CD Changer . 142..................................Ceiling Light . 111

........................Certification Label . 306............................................Chains . 256

Changing Oil........................................How to . 225......................................When to . 214

....................Changing a Flat Tire . 279............Changing Engine Coolant . 230

...Charging System Indicator . 59, 292............Checklist, Before Driving . 178

..................Childproof Door Locks . 84.....................................Child Safety . 21

.......................................Child Seats . 26..........Tether Anchorage Points . 41

....................Cleaner Element, Air . 238

Cleaning....................Aluminum Wheels . 271

...................................Carpeting . 272......................................Exterior . 270.......................................Interior . 272.......................................Leather . 273

...................................Seat Belts . 273...........................................Vinyl . 273

....................................Windows . 274.......Climate Control System . 116, 123

.........................Clock, Setting the . 105..........................CO in the Exhaust . 53

........................................Coin Box . 106............Cold Weather, Starting in . 179

..............................Compact Spare . 278.................Console Compartment . 106...............Consumer Information . 320

.............Controls, Instruments and . 55Coolant

........................................Adding . 228....................................Checking . 169

.........................Proper Solution . 228...................................Replacing . 230

...................Temperature Gauge . 66....................Corrosion Protection . 275

Crankcase Emissions Control........................................System . 314

............Cruise Control Operation . 153..........Customer Relations Office . 320

................DANGER, Explanation of . ii...................................Dashboard . 2, 56

................Daytime Running Lights . 70............Defects, Reporting Safety . 323

................Defogger, Rear Window . 74

......Defrosting the Windows . 122, 127....................................Dimensions . 308

...............Dimming the Headlights . 69Dipstick

..........Automatic Transmission . 234..................................Engine Oil . 168

..........................Directional Signals . 71........Disc Brake Wear Indicators . 190

.....................Disposal of Used Oil . 227Doors

..............................Monitor Light . 62......................Power Door Locks . 79

..........DOT Tire Quality Grading . 310.....................................Drive Belts . 249

Index

C

D

II

00/12/25 14:47:20 31S0K630_331

Page 332: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

...........Driver and Passenger Safety . 5...........................................Driving . 177

....................................Economy . 170.........................In Bad Weather . 199

................In Foreign Countries . 313Driving Position Memory

..........................................System . 96

..............................Economy, Fuel . 170............Emergencies on the Road . 277.............Battery, Jump Starting . 286...........Brake System Indicator . 295

................Changing a Flat Tire . 279.....Charging System Indicator . 292

..................Checking the Fuses . 297.....Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 291...Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 293...Manually Closing Moonroof . 296

..................Overheated Engine . 289.........................Emergency Brake . 104

......................Emergency Flashers . 73......................Emergency Towing . 302

............Emergency Trunk Opener . 86.......................Emissions Controls . 314

.............Emissions Testing, State . 317Engine

............................................Belts . 249....Coolant Temperature Gauge . 66

Malfunction Indicator................................Lamp . 59, 293

........Oil Pressure Indicator . 59, 291

..............Oil, What Kind to Use . 223...............................Overheating . 289

............................Specifications . 309

............................Speed Limiter . 187.......................................Starting . 179

......................Ethanol in Gasoline . 312.Evaporative Emissions Controls . 314

...............................Exhaust Fumes . 53Expectant Mothers, Use of Seat

........................................Belts by . 19..................Exterior, Cleaning the . 270

..........................Fan, Interior . 120, 125Features, Comfort and

..............................Convenience . 115....................Filling the Fuel Tank . 165

Filter................................Air Cleaner . 238

.......................Air Conditioning . 249...............................................Oil . 225

.............Flashers, Hazard Warning . 73...................Flat Tire, Changing a . 279

.....................................Floor Mats . 272Fluids

..........Automatic Transmission . 234..........................................Brake . 236

..........................Power Steering . 237................Windshield Washers . 233

FM Stereo Radio...................................Reception . 135

........................................Fog Lights . 70.....Foreign Countries, Driving in . 313

..........................Four-way Flashers . 73..............................Front Airbags . 9, 47

.................................................Fuel . 164......................Fill Door and Cap . 165

...........................................Gauge . 66................Octane Requirement . 164

...............................Oxygenated . 312........................Reserve Indicator . 63

........................Tank, Filling the . 165

Index

E

F

III

00/12/25 14:47:26 31S0K630_332

Page 333: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

.....................Fuses, Checking the . 297

........................Jacking up the Car . 281.......................................Jack, Tire . 280

................................Jump Starting . 286...Identification Number, Vehicle . 306

Ignition..............................................Keys . 76

...........................................Switch . 78............Timing Control System . 315

........................Immobilizer System . 77.........Important Safety Precautions . 6

.........Indicators, Instrument Panel . 57...............................Infant Restraint . 30

......................................Infant Seats . 30..........Tether Anchorage Points . 41

...................Inflation, Proper Tire . 251...................................Inside Mirror . 94

.............................Inspection, Tire . 252............................Instrument Panel . 57

........Instrument Panel Brightness . 71...........................Interior Cleaning . 272

...............................Interior Lights . 111........................................Introduction . i

.............Halogen Headlight Bulbs . 259..............Hazard Warning Flashers . 73

........................................Headlights . 69........................................Aiming . 259

Automatic Lighting Off.....................................Feature . 70

............Daytime Running Lights . 70..................High Beam Indicator . 62

.........................Reminder Chime . 69........Replacing Halogen Bulbs . 259

...................................Turning on . 69..............................Head Restraints . 91

.............High Altitude, Starting at . 179.................High-Low Beam Switch . 69

HomeLink Universal................................Transceiver . 157

....................................Hood Latch . 237.......................Hood, Opening the . 166

.................................Hydroplaning . 200

...............Gas Mileage, Improving . 170..........................................Gasohol . 312.........................................Gasoline . 164

...............Fuel Reserve Indicator . 63...........................................Gauge . 66

................Octane Requirement . 164........................Tank, Filling the . 165

................Gas Station Procedures . 164Gauges

...Engine Coolant Temperature . 66...............................................Fuel . 66

...............................Speedometer . 64.................................Tachometer . 64

GAWR (Gross Axle Weight.......................................Rating) . 202

Gearshift Lever Positions..........Automatic Transmission . 180

..............................Glass Cleaning . 274........................................Glove Box . 87

GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight.......................................Rating) . 202

Index

G

H

I

J

IV

00/12/26 12:34:50 31S0K630_333

Page 334: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

...................Neutral Gear Position . 183..................New Vehicle Break-in . 164

...................NOTICE, Explanation of . i...............Numbers, Identification . 306

..................................................Keys . 76

.......................Label, Certification . 306.................Lane Change, Signaling . 71

..................Lap/Shoulder Belts . 15, 44Lights

....................Bulb Replacement . 259.......................................Indicator . 57

.........................................Parking . 69..................................Turn Signal . 71

.....................................Load Limit . 174......LOCK (Ignition Key Position) . 78

........................Lockout Prevention . 80Locks

.......Anti-theft Steering Column . 78............................Fuel Fill Door . 165

....................................Glove Box . 87.................................Power Door . 79

...........................................Trunk . 85........................Low Coolant Level . 169

...Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 59, 291...Lubricant Specifications Chart . 308

.........................................Luggage . 173

..................................Maintenance . 209...Owner Maintenance Checks . 221

........................................Record . 219......................Required Indicator . 67

..........................................Safety . 210.............................Schedule . 214-218

Malfunction Indicator....................................Lamp . 59, 293

.............Memory, Driving Position . 96...............................Meters, Gauges . 64

...................Methanol in Gasoline . 312..........................Mirrors, Adjusting . 94

.......................................Moonroof . 103......................Closing Manually . 296

...................................Operation . 103

...Octane Requirement, Gasoline . 164.........................................Odometer . 65

...............................Odometer, Trip . 65Oil

........................Change, How to . 225......................Change, When to . 214......................Checking Engine . 168..............Pressure Indicator . 59, 291

Selecting Proper Viscosity......................................Chart . 224

...........ON (Ignition Key Position) . 79Onboard Refueling Vapor

....................................Recovery . 314..Operation in Foreign Countries . 313

..............................Outside Mirrors . 94....................Overheating, Engine . 289

.......Owner Maintenance Checks . 221.........................Oxygenated Fuels . 312

Index

K

L

N

O

M

V

00/12/25 14:47:41 31S0K630_334

Page 335: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

*..................................Safety Belts . 8, 44

.........Safety Defects, Reporting . 323.................................Safety Features . 7

...........................................Airbags . 9..................................Door Locks . 10

..........................Head Restraints . 10.......................................Seat Belts . 8

.....................Seats & Seat-Backs . 10.............Safety Labels, Location of . 54

...............................Safety Messages . ii.....................................Seat Belts . 8, 44

...............Additional Information . 44.....................................Cleaning . 273

................Lap/Shoulder Belt . 15, 44................................Maintenance . 46

Reminder Light and................................Beeper . 44, 59

..............................Paint Touch-up . 271..............Panel Brightness Control . 71

........................Park Gear Position . 182...........................................Parking . 189

...............................Parking Brake . 104Parking Brake and Brake System

...............................Indicator . 59, 295.................................Parking Lights . 69

..Parking Over Things that Burn . 189.............................PGM-FI System . 315

..................Polishing and Waxing . 271............Pre-Drive Safety Checklist . 11

.........Pregnancy, Using Seat Belts . 19............................Protecting Adults . 12

...Additional Safety Precautions . 20.....Advice for Pregnant Women . 19

........................Protecting Children . 21.......................Protecting Infants . 30

.......Protecting Larger Children . 37.........Protecting Small Children . 34

Using Child Seats with.....................................Tethers . 41

...................Radiator Overheating . 289Radio/Cassette/CD Sound

........................................System . 129...................Readiness Codes . 294, 317

..Rear Lights, Bulb Replacement . 263..........................Rear Seat Armrest . 92

............................Rear View Mirror . 94.................Rear Window Defogger . 74...............Reclining the Seat Backs . 89

.............................Reminder Lights . 57................Remote Audio Controls . 150

.......................Remote Transmitter . 81Replacement Information

.................Air Cleaner Element . 238.............Air Conditioning Filter . 249

..........................Engine Coolant . 230................Engine Oil and Filter . 225

..........................................Fuses . 298................................Light Bulbs . 259

....................................Schedule . 214................................Spark Plugs . 240

...........................................Tires . 254.............................Wiper Blades . 246

Replacing Seat Belts After a............................................Crash . 46

...Reserve Tank, Engine Coolant . 169...............................Restraint, Child . 21

..................Reverse Gear Position . 182................................Rotation, Tire . 254

Index

P R

S

VI

00/12/25 14:47:47 31S0K630_335

Page 336: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

CONTINUED

...................System Components . 44...............Use During Pregnancy . 19

....................................Seat Heaters . 99........................Seats, Adjusting the . 88

............................Security System . 152........Sequential SportShift Mode . 183

...............................Serial Number . 306...........................Service Intervals . 214...........................Service Manual . 325

.........Service Station Procedures . 165..........................Setting the Clock . 105

.....Shift Lever Position Indicator . 180........................Shift Lock Release . 187

................................Side Airbags . 9, 49...............Side Airbag Indicator . 51, 60

Side Marker Lights, Bulb..............................Replacement . 260...............................Signaling Turns . 71

.....................................Snow Tires . 256...................Solvent-type Cleaners . 270

................................Sound System . 129Spare Tire

......................................Inflating . 278............................Specifications . 309

................Spark Plugs, Replacing . 240....................Specifications Charts . 308

................................Speed Control . 153...................................Speedometer . 64

.......................................Spotlights . 112..........SRS, Additional Information . 47

...Additional Safety Precautions . 52How the SRS Indicator

.......................................Works . 50...........How Your Airbags Work . 47

........................SRS Components . 47..................................SRS Service . 52

.............................SRS Indicator . 50, 60....START (Ignition Key Position) . 79

.......................Starting the Engine . 179In Cold Weather at High

..................................Altitude . 179................With a Dead Battery . 286..............State Emissions Testing . 317

........Steam Coming from Engine . 289Steering Wheel

..................................Adjustment . 75.............Anti-theft Column Lock . 78

...................Stereo Sound System . 129...........................Storing Your Car . 267

........................................Sun Visor . 109........................Sunglasses Holder . 110

....Supplemental Restraint System . 47......................................Servicing . 52

...............................SRS Indicator . 50...................System Components . 47

.....................................Tachometer . 64......Taillights, Changing Bulbs in . 263

.Taking Care of the Unexpected . 277....................................Tape Player . 137

Technical Descriptions......DOT Tire Quality Grading . 310.....Emissions Control Systems . 314

.....................Oxygenated Fuels . 312Three Way Catalytic

...............................Converter . 316.......................Temperature Gauge . 66

..............Tether Anchorage Points . 41..Three Way Catalytic Converter . 316

..........................Time, Setting the . 105....................................Timing Belt . 250....................................Tire Chains . 256

.........Tire, How to Change a Flat . 279

Index

T

VII

00/12/25 14:47:52 31S0K630_336

Page 337: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

.....................Underside, Cleaning . 275Unexpected, Taking Care

..........................................of the . 277....Uniform Tire Quality Grading . 310

........................Unleaded Gasoline . 164.....................Upholstery Cleaning . 272

.......Used Oil, How to Dispose of . 227

.............WARNING, Explanation of . ii.........Warning Labels, Location of . 54

..................Warranty Coverages . 322Washer, Windshield

........Checking the Fluid Level . 233.......................................Indicator . 63.....................................Operation . 73

.........................................Washing . 270..................Waxing and Polishing . 271

Wheels...............Adjusting the Steering . 75............Alignment and Balance . 253

..........................Compact Spare . 278

...............................................Tires . 250..............................Air Pressure . 251

.........................Checking Wear . 252..........................Compact Spare . 278

......DOT Tire Quality Grading . 310......................................Inflation . 251

..................................Inspection . 252...................................Replacing . 254

......................................Rotating . 254...........................................Snow . 256

............................Specifications . 309.......................Traction Devices . 256

..........................Winter Driving . 256...................Tools, Tire Changing . 279

Towing.....................................A Trailer . 201

................Emergency Wrecker . 302Traction Control System (TCS)

...............................Indicator . 61, 195...................................Operation . 193

...........................Traction Devices . 256Transmission

Checking Fluid Level,..............................Automatic . 234

...........................Fluid Selection . 235..............Identification Number . 307

.............Shifting the Automatic . 180.............................Treadwear . 252, 310.......................................Trip Meter . 65

................................................Trunk . 85........Emergency Trunk Release . 86

.................................Opening the . 85...................Open Monitor Light . 62

....................................Turn Signals . 71

................................Vanity Mirror . 109.................Vehicle Capacity Load . 174

......................Vehicle Dimensions . 308....Vehicle Identification Number . 306

Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA)....................................System . 196

........VSA System Indicator . 61, 196...VSA Activation Indicator . 61, 197

.........................VSA Off Switch . 197.............................Vehicle Storage . 267

.................................................VIN . 306...............................Vinyl Cleaning . 273

..................................Viscosity, Oil . 224

Index

U

V

W

VIII

00/12/25 14:47:59 31S0K630_337

Page 338: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

*Windows.....................................Cleaning . 274

................Operating the Power . 100...........................Rear, Defogger . 74

Windshield.......................................Cleaning . 72...........................Defroster . 122, 125

.......................................Washers . 73Wipers, Windshield

.......................Changing Blades . 246.....................................Operation . 72

....................................Worn Tires . 252.....Wrecker, Emergency Towing . 302

: U.S. and Canada only

Index

IX

00/12/25 14:48:03 31S0K630_338

Page 339: 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manualtechinfo.honda.com/rjanisis/pubs/OM/AH/BT10202OM/enu/TL0202OM.pdf · 2002 TL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout

Service Information Summary

Gasoline: Tire Pressure (measured cold):Power Steering Fluid:

Brake Fluid:

Automatic Transmission Fluid:

Recommended Engine Oil:

Fuel Tank Capacity:Spare Tire Pressure:

4.6 US qt (4.4 , 3.9 Imp qt)

Oil change capacity (includingfilter):

Premium unleaded gasoline,pump octane number of 91 orhigher.

Honda ATF-Z1 (AutomaticTransmission Fluid) preferred, ora DEXRON III ATF as atemporary replacement (see page

).

Honda Power Steering Fluidpreferred, or another brand ofpower steering fluid as atemporary replacement. Do notuse ATF (see page ).

Honda Heavy Duty Brake FluidDOT 3 preferred, or a DOT 3 orDOT 4 brake fluid as a temporaryreplacement (see page ).

32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )

60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )

Front/Rear:

API Service SJ ‘‘EnergyConserving’’ oil, SAE 5W-20viscosity (see page ).223

235

237

236

17.17 US gal (65.0 , 14.30 Imp gal)

00/12/25 14:48:17 31S0K630_339